Avaya 580 manuel d'utilisation
- Voir en ligne ou télécharger le manuel d’utilisation
- 782 pages
- 5.68 mb
Aller à la page of
Les manuels d’utilisation similaires
-
Switch
Avaya 3500YL
21 pages 0.37 mb -
Switch
Avaya C460 SMON
102 pages 1.06 mb -
Switch
Avaya 700234750
14 pages 0.53 mb -
Switch
Avaya P333T
12 pages 0.11 mb -
Switch
Avaya P880
43 pages 0.2 mb -
Switch
Avaya M-ACCF/SF
114 pages 2.32 mb -
Switch
Avaya P460
86 pages 2.03 mb -
Switch
Avaya P332G-ML
164 pages 1.54 mb
Un bon manuel d’utilisation
Les règles imposent au revendeur l'obligation de fournir à l'acheteur, avec des marchandises, le manuel d’utilisation Avaya 580. Le manque du manuel d’utilisation ou les informations incorrectes fournies au consommateur sont à la base d'une plainte pour non-conformité du dispositif avec le contrat. Conformément à la loi, l’inclusion du manuel d’utilisation sous une forme autre que le papier est autorisée, ce qui est souvent utilisé récemment, en incluant la forme graphique ou électronique du manuel Avaya 580 ou les vidéos d'instruction pour les utilisateurs. La condition est son caractère lisible et compréhensible.
Qu'est ce que le manuel d’utilisation?
Le mot vient du latin "Instructio", à savoir organiser. Ainsi, le manuel d’utilisation Avaya 580 décrit les étapes de la procédure. Le but du manuel d’utilisation est d’instruire, de faciliter le démarrage, l'utilisation de l'équipement ou l'exécution des actions spécifiques. Le manuel d’utilisation est une collection d'informations sur l'objet/service, une indice.
Malheureusement, peu d'utilisateurs prennent le temps de lire le manuel d’utilisation, et un bon manuel permet non seulement d’apprendre à connaître un certain nombre de fonctionnalités supplémentaires du dispositif acheté, mais aussi éviter la majorité des défaillances.
Donc, ce qui devrait contenir le manuel parfait?
Tout d'abord, le manuel d’utilisation Avaya 580 devrait contenir:
- informations sur les caractéristiques techniques du dispositif Avaya 580
- nom du fabricant et année de fabrication Avaya 580
- instructions d'utilisation, de réglage et d’entretien de l'équipement Avaya 580
- signes de sécurité et attestations confirmant la conformité avec les normes pertinentes
Pourquoi nous ne lisons pas les manuels d’utilisation?
Habituellement, cela est dû au manque de temps et de certitude quant à la fonctionnalité spécifique de l'équipement acheté. Malheureusement, la connexion et le démarrage Avaya 580 ne suffisent pas. Le manuel d’utilisation contient un certain nombre de lignes directrices concernant les fonctionnalités spécifiques, la sécurité, les méthodes d'entretien (même les moyens qui doivent être utilisés), les défauts possibles Avaya 580 et les moyens de résoudre des problèmes communs lors de l'utilisation. Enfin, le manuel contient les coordonnées du service Avaya en l'absence de l'efficacité des solutions proposées. Actuellement, les manuels d’utilisation sous la forme d'animations intéressantes et de vidéos pédagogiques qui sont meilleurs que la brochure, sont très populaires. Ce type de manuel permet à l'utilisateur de voir toute la vidéo d'instruction sans sauter les spécifications et les descriptions techniques compliquées Avaya 580, comme c’est le cas pour la version papier.
Pourquoi lire le manuel d’utilisation?
Tout d'abord, il contient la réponse sur la structure, les possibilités du dispositif Avaya 580, l'utilisation de divers accessoires et une gamme d'informations pour profiter pleinement de toutes les fonctionnalités et commodités.
Après un achat réussi de l’équipement/dispositif, prenez un moment pour vous familiariser avec toutes les parties du manuel d'utilisation Avaya 580. À l'heure actuelle, ils sont soigneusement préparés et traduits pour qu'ils soient non seulement compréhensibles pour les utilisateurs, mais pour qu’ils remplissent leur fonction de base de l'information et d’aide.
Table des matières du manuel d’utilisation
-
Page 1
User Guide for the Avaya P580 and P882 Multiservice Switches Softwa re Version 6.1 Doc. No. 10-300077 Issue 2 May 2004[...]
-
Page 2
User Guide for the A vaya P580 and P882 Multiservice Switches, Software V ersion 6.1 © Copyright A vaya Inc., 2004 ALL RIGHTS RESER VED Produced in US A, May 2004 The produc ts, spe cificat ions, and oth er techni cal i nformat ion regar ding t he prod ucts conta ined i n this documen t are subjec t to change wit hout noti ce. All i nfo rmatio n i[...]
-
Page 3
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 iii T able of Content s Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvii Preface Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvii Overview of User Guide [...]
-
Page 4
iv User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Table o f Contents Chapter 2 — Setting Up the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Setting Up Your La ptop or PC [...]
-
Page 5
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 v Table of Contents Enabling the Simple Networ k Time Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 Setting Summer Time Hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 Setting Recur ring Summer Time Hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 6
vi User G uide for th e Avaya P580 and P882 Multiser vice Sw itches, v6.1 Table o f Contents Localized Ke ys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Engine ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Timeliness Checks . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 7
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 vii Table of Contents Egress Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6 -6 Creating and Impl ementing VLANs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 VLAN Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 8
viii User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Table o f Contents Using th e All Module Ports Con figuration W eb Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-39 Viewing Switc h Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-41 Configuring Por t Redundancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 9
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 ix Table of Contents Superviso r Module Redundancy Stat istics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-13 Active and Sta ndby Roles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-13 Synchronizat ion Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 10
x User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Table o f Contents Configur ing the DVMRP Global Confi guration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-35 Modifying a DVMRP Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-38 Monitoring Swit ch Performance Usin g IP Statist ics . . . . . . . . . . . [...]
-
Page 11
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xi Table of Contents Recognizing Pe rformance Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20 Evaluating Sy stem Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-21 Enabling Routi ng at the Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1[...]
-
Page 12
xii User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Sw itches, v6.1 Table o f Contents Chapter 16 — Config uring IPX Routin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 6-1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-1 IPX Overview . . . . . . . . . . [...]
-
Page 13
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xiii Table of Contents Deleting an App l eTalk Inte rface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-9 Creating an App leTalk Stati c Route . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 9-10 Editing AppleTal k Static Routes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 14
xiv User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Sw itches, v6.1 Table o f Contents Enabling CGMP Snoopi ng . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-33 Viewing CGMP Snoopin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-35 Chapter 21 — Monit oring the Avaya M ultiser vice Switch [...]
-
Page 15
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xv Table of Contents Chapter 24 — Managing Bu ffers and Queues on 50-Series Modules . . . . . 24-1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-1 How Queues Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . [...]
-
Page 16
xvi User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Table o f Contents Resetting the QoS Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-51 Display ing the Buffer Settings for Egre ss Queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-52 Appendix A — Upgr ading the App lication Softw are . . . . . .[...]
-
Page 17
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 xvii Preface Preface Co ntent s This Prefa ce contains the foll owing informati on: ■ Overview of Use r Guide Contents ■ T echnic al Support ■ A vaya Pr oducts and Services ■ P580 and P882 Documentation ■ Document Conve ntions ■ T erminology ■ Documentat ion Feedba[...]
-
Page 18
xviii User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Preface This guid e is divided in t o the follow ing chapte rs: ■ Chapter 1 , Introdu cti on — Provides an overview of hardware a nd software used on the P580 and P8 82. ■ Chapter 2 , Setti ng Up the Sw itc h — Explains ho w to init ially configure the P580 and P88[...]
-
Page 19
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xix Preface ■ Chapter 1 5 , Configuring the OSPF Routi ng Protocol — Explain s how to c onfigure OSPF routing protoc ol on your swit ch. Also provided is informat ion on OSPF sta tistical dis plays. ■ Chapter 1 6 , Configur ing IPX Routin g — Explains how to co nfigure IPX on your switch. ■ Chapter 1[...]
-
Page 20
xx User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6 .1 Preface T echnical Suppo rt T o conta ct A vaya’ s techni cal support: ■ From the United S tates: 1-800-237- 0016 ■ From Nort h America: 1-800-242- 2121 ■ Out sid e N ort h Am er ica: Contact you r distributor A vaya Produc t s and Services See the A vaya W orld W id[...]
-
Page 21
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xxi Preface ■ Release N otes f or the A vaya P580 and P882 Multi service Switch es, Softwar e V ersion 6.1 lists ne w so f twa re fe a ture s, r esolv ed issu es, and known i ssues in v6.1 appli c ation software. ■ Function al Restriction s for the A vaya P580 and P882 Mul t iservice Switches , Softwar e V[...]
-
Page 22
xxii User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Preface 3. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Syste m > C onf igur ation folde rs, and then c lick Online Help . The Onlin e Help Configuration W eb page is dis played in t he content pan e. 4. In the HTTP Server Location field , ent er th e U R L of the W eb ser ver [...]
-
Page 23
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 xxiii Preface W ARNIN G: CAUTION: Notes, Caut ions, and W arnings The followi ng text a nd icon convention s are used in thi s guide for Notes, Cautions, a nd W arnings. * Note: Provides addi tional i nformation about a procedure or t opic. Indicates a condi ti on that may cause bodily inj ury or death. Indica[...]
-
Page 24
xxiv User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Preface T erminology Throughout this guide, the term layer 2 refers to swit chi ng cap ab ili ty . Fo r example, l ayer 2 module is a m odule that pro vides switching capability . The term la yer 3 refe rs to th e com bi ne d ab i lity to swi tch and ro ute . For example, l[...]
-
Page 25
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 1-1 1 Introduct ion Ove rview The followi ng information i s provide d in this chap ter: ■ Swit ch De scr ipti ons ■ Hardware Co mponents ■ Softw ar e F eat ure s ■ Routing Ove r view Switch D escriptions The A vaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice swit ches are high per fo[...]
-
Page 26
1-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 1 Hardware Compone nt s Overview Cha ssis The A va ya s wit ch ch assi s co mes i n tw o mo dels : ■ The P580 chas sis. ■ The P882 chas sis. The P580 and P882 chassis can r un in two modes: ■ Fabric Mo de 1 = 55 MHz or Fabr ic_mode 1 ■ Fabric Mo de 2 = 66M[...]
-
Page 27
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-3 Introdu ction ■ The Power Sys t em ■ The M8000R-SUP Sup ervisor Module ■ Media Module s A v aya P580 Multiservice Switch Ch assis The A vaya P5 80 Multiser vice Swit ch chassis consi sts of: ■ Seven slo ts (1 slot for the supervis or module an d six payload s lots for media modules ) ■ Fan T ray [...]
-
Page 28
1-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 1 Switch Fabric In Fabri c mode 1, the switching fabri c provides 45.76 Gbps agg regate bandwidth . In Fabric mode 2 (P5 80 only), the s witching fabri c provides 54.91 Gbps ag gregate bandwidt h. The cross bar switch matrix pr ovides low laten cy , high thr oughp[...]
-
Page 29
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-5 Introdu ction A v aya P882 Multiservice Switch Ch assis The A vaya P8 82 Multiser vice Switch Chass i s consists of: ■ Seventee n slots (1 slot for the supervi sor module and six teen payload s lots for media mod ules) ■ Fan T ray ■ Up to three pow e r su pplie s ■ A 33x33 cros sbar switch fab ric [...]
-
Page 30
1-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 1 Switch Fabric In Fabr ic mode 1, the swit ching fabric pr ovides a 16x16 cr ossbar wi th 56.32 Gbps aggregat e bandwidt h. In Fabric mode 2, the switchi ng fabri c provide s a 33x33 cr ossbar with 139.392 Gbps aggregate ban dwidth. The cross bar switch matrix pr[...]
-
Page 31
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-7 Introdu ction St atic P ower Allocation The swit ch uses stat ic power allocati on at st art up when the swit ch has insuf ficient p ower to tur n on all module s in the chassis . When usin g stat ic powe r all ocati on, the switc h tu rns on the modu le in sl ot 2 (slot 3 i f slot 2 contai ns a redundant [...]
-
Page 32
1-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 1 3. Modules 1 1 and 12 remain turned of f. 4. M o dul e 13 is turn ed on . 5. Modules 14 th rough 17 remain turned of f becaus e all availabl e power is now cons umed. The M8000R-SUP Supervis or Module Functions The M8000R-SUP super visor module is r e sponsible [...]
-
Page 33
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-9 Introdu ction ■ Real -time clo ck ■ Out-of- band consol e: 10/100BASE-T and RS-2 32 ■ Dot ma trix disp lay ■ System management fu nctions and i nterfac es ■ 1.5 milli on packets per se cond of hardware- based rout ing for packets that arrive on layer 2-o nly media modules T able 1-1. Supported Me[...]
-
Page 34
1-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 Redundant Supervisor The re dundant supervis or module is an auxiliary (stand by) superviso r mod ul e th at ac ts a s a fau lt-to l eran t su p erv isor in the eve nt tha t the act ive supervi sor fails. The r edundant supervi s or provides a se amless solution [...]
-
Page 35
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-11 Introdu ction 50-S eri es Me dia Module s Ta b l e 1 - 2 lists the 5 0-serie s (also call ed seri es 1 ), layer 2 and layer 3, Fas t Ethernet m odules that t he A vaya P580 and P88 2 Multiservic e swit ches support. * Note: HD X stands for Half Du plex, FDX stan ds for Full Dup lex. Ta b l e 1 - 3 lists t[...]
-
Page 36
1-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 80-Ser i es Medi a Modules Ta b l e 1 - 4 list s t he 8 0-s er ies (als o ca lle d se rie s 2 ), 10-Gigabit modules that the A vay a P580 and P88 2 Multiservice s witches support. Ta b l e 1 - 5 lists the 80- ser ie s Gi gabi t m odules t hat t he A vaya P580 and[...]
-
Page 37
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-13 Introdu ction T ab le 1-5. 80- Series Gigabit Modul es Mod el Nu mber Descript ion M8004R- 1000GB 4 -port, Gigabit Interface Card (GBIC) base d module. This module can be conf igured wit h up to 4 GBIC optical modules . The 4- port GBIC module s upports t he followi ng GBIC-type connecto rs: • 1000BAS E[...]
-
Page 38
1-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 Ta b l e 1 - 6 lists the 80- ser ies Fast Ethern et modules that th e A vaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice swit ches suppor t. AT M U p l i n k Module There ar e four variations of the A TM Uplink mod ule: ■ 2-port Syn chronous Optical N ET work (S ONET)/ Sync hr[...]
-
Page 39
1-15 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 The maj or featur es of the A TM Uplink module ar e: ■ LANE V2 Client - with LANE 1 compat ibilit y , support s 128 inte rfac es ■ QoS (Quality of Service) support f or UBR, nrt-VBR, rt-VBR, and CBR ■ A TM UNI (User -to-Networ k Interface) V 3. 0, 3.1 and 4[...]
-
Page 40
1-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 Security The P580 and P882 support t he followi ng security fea tures: ■ Secure Mod e—Secure mode rest ricts management of the switch to the foll owing secure prot ocols: HTTPS, SSH, and SNMPv3. For info rm at ion on sec ure mod e, see Chapter 4 , “ Securi [...]
-
Page 41
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-17 Introdu ction The hardwar e on all mult iservice switches suppor t port-base d VLANs with the fo llowing cha racterist ics: ■ Frames cl assified as Lay e r 1 (port-base d) when they enter the switc h ■ Explici tly tagge d VLAN packets — these are forwa rded base d on the in for m atio n in th e pac [...]
-
Page 42
1-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 ■ Dual-Layer Spanning T ree ■ Global Disa ble For more i nformation about Spanning Tree, s ee Chapter 7 , “ Configuring Rapi d S pa nni ng T ree .” Extens ive F ault T oleranc e All multi service switches a r e designed to f unction a s backbone switche s[...]
-
Page 43
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-19 Introdu ction Routing Pro toc ols The P580 and P88 2 support the fol lowing routing p rotocols: ■ IRD P . For i nfo rmati on o n IRD P , s ee Chapter 12 , “ Configurin g IP Routing .” ■ RIP . For i nformation on RIP , see Chapter 14 , “ Conf iguring RIP Routing .” ■ OSPF . For in formation o[...]
-
Page 44
1-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 50-Series Buffers and Qu eues Buff er and queue manage m ent rel ieves congestion i n a network. Addi ng gigabit speeds to exis ting n etwo rks means that t here c an be a hug e di sparity between l ink speeds . For example , anyth ing more than a 1-pe rcent lo a[...]
-
Page 45
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-21 Introdu ction System Management The P580 and P88 2 support the fol lowing system management fe atures: ■ LDAP . For inf ormation on LDAP , see Chapter 12 , “ Configur ing IP Routing .” ■ RMON. For info rmation on RMON, see Chapter 2 3 , “ Using RMON and Ether net Statist ics to Analyze Netw ork [...]
-
Page 46
1-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1 * Note: La yer 2 traf fic that does no t require rout ing is bridg ed indepen dently of the layer 3 t raffic b ased on the MAC addr ess or VLAN info rmation. Routing with Layer 2 an d Layer 3 Module s When a switc h contains a combi nation of layer 2 and layer 3 [...]
-
Page 47
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 1-23 Introdu ction ■ Since la yer 2 modules have n o routing capa bility , pack ets that are receive d by a layer 2 module an d require routing are for warded by sending t he packet to the 50-series layer 3 or 80-series supe rvisor module. The rout ing engine on the superviso r modul e then pe rforms the rou[...]
-
Page 48
1-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 1[...]
-
Page 49
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 2-1 2 Setting Up the Switch Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es that are pro vided in t his chapter are common to both layer 2 and laye r 3 module: ■ Set t i ng U p Y our Lap t op o r PC ■ Perfo rmin g Init ial S etup of th e Swit ch ■ Usin g T eln et to[...]
-
Page 50
2-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 2 Settin g Up Y our Laptop or PC Y ou need a lap top or PC to make a serial line connection to the switch to com plet e init ial s w itch set up . Ta b l e 2 - 1 l ists the sett ings required f or the lapto p or PC to comm un i cate wi th the swi tch. Performin g [...]
-
Page 51
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-3 Setting Up th e Switch Figure 2-1. A vaya P580 Mul t iservice Swit ch Front V iew 2. Run a te rminal emulatio n program (Hyp erT erminal, for exam pl e) on the attache d laptop or PC. V erify that t he lap top or PC moni tor settings match thos e listed in Ta b l e 2 - 1 . 3. T urn on t he switch. The s wi[...]
-
Page 52
2-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 2 * Note: A vaya strongl y recommen ds that you change the default pas swor d. d. Enter the IP address for the s witch manager’ s Ethernet console. e. Enter the subnet mas k . f. Ente r the default g ateway for the swi tch. The foll owing is a sampl e outpu t of[...]
-
Page 53
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-5 Setting Up th e Switch Y ou can now connect to the switch us ing the front- panel out-of-ba nd 10Base-T con nection. This all ows you to log in us ing either the embedded W eb Agent or the EMS. See the In stallatio n and Operat ion guides fo r instruction on establish ing addition al IP network conne ction[...]
-
Page 54
2-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 2 ■ V iewing Active T e lnet Sess ions ■ T elnet Sessi on Expirat ion Ti mer As a more secur e alt ernat ive to T elnet, you can use SSHv2. Fo r infor mat ion on using a n SSH connection to m anage th e switch, see “ SSHv2 ” in Chapter 4 , “ Securi ty .?[...]
-
Page 55
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-7 Setting Up th e Switch Although it is possible t o establish nes ted T elnet sessio ns, A vaya recommends tha t you estab lish a separate T el net session f or each switch t hat you want to ma nage. A nested T elnet session occurs wh en you esta blish a T elnet sess ion from a c lient to one switc h, then [...]
-
Page 56
2-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 2 CAUTION: Ta b l e 2 - 3 lists the minimum, maximum, an d default v alues for the T elnet inactiv ity t imer . A vaya recommend s that you not disable th e inactivity timer . If t he inactivit y timer is disabled and the maximum number of T elnet sessions is open[...]
-
Page 57
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-9 Setting Up th e Switch Opening th e W e b Agent Although th e W eb Agent is su pported by any fr ames-capable brows er , the syst em has be en s pec if ica lly q ual if ied onl y wi th the foll o win g bro wse r s: ■ Microsof t Internet Expl orer 5.5 or late r . T o download Mic r osoft Intern et Explore[...]
-
Page 58
2-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 2. Enter Networ k Password Di alog Box 5. In the User Name field, ent er a valid user name. The default s uper user name is ro ot . 6. In the Password field, ente r a va lid pas sw or d. Th e defa ult pas sw or d is roo t . 7. Click OK . The General Inf[...]
-
Page 59
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-11 Setting Up th e Switch Figure 2-3. G eneral Information W eb Page Loggi ng Out of the We b Agent T o exit the W eb Agent secu rely , you must log out o f the W eb Agent and close all open browser windo w s. If you do not log out and cl ose al l open browse r wi ndows , i t is pos si ble that another us er[...]
-
Page 60
2-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 T o log out of the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the System folde r. 2. Click Logout . The Logou t W eb page is displ ayed in t he content pane. See Figur e 2-4 . Figure 2- 4. Logout W e b Page 3. Click YES to log out . 4. Close all ot her open [...]
-
Page 61
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-13 Setting Up th e Switch After cre ating one or mo re custom ac cess types (use r profiles), y ou can cr ea te a u ser acc ount and assi gn a cus to m a cce ss typ e to that acc o unt . The user is then able to man age the switch based on the cus tom access t ype that was assigne d to his or her u ser accou[...]
-
Page 62
2-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 6. Create Cust om Access T ype W eb Page 3. In the Ty p e N a m e fiel d, enter a name for the custo m access type. Y ou can ent er up to 31 charac ters. Do not us e spaces. 4. For each f eature in th e Accessi ble Feat ures li st, sele ct the permissio[...]
-
Page 63
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-15 Setting Up th e Switch Modifying a Custom Access T ype Web A g e n t Procedure T o modify a cust om access t ype: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Syst em > Administ ration folders , and then c lick Custom Access T ypes . The Custom Acce ss T ypes W eb page i s displa yed in the content pane. S[...]
-
Page 64
2-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 CLI Command T o modify a cu stom access ty pe, use the foll owing CLI command: (configure)# set c ust om-a cce ss- type <catName> [sys -con fig urati on {ro | rw | none}] [modul e-port-mgmt {r o | rw | none}] [events-mgmt {r o | rw | none}] [l2- switching {[...]
-
Page 65
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-17 Setting Up th e Switch CLI Command T o delete a cust om access t ype, use the foll owing CLI command: (configure)# n o custom-acc ess-type <cat n a m e > Configuring Us er Account s This sect ion contains pro cedures for t he foll owing tasks: ■ Configur ing User Account Sec urity ■ Creatin g a [...]
-
Page 66
2-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 9. User Account Management W eb Page 3. In the Log in A tt em p ts fiel d, enter the nu mber of logi n att empts t hat you want to a llow users. When a us er exceeds the l i mit for login att empts, his or her user account is disabled and the switch dis[...]
-
Page 67
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-19 Setting Up th e Switch CLI Commands T o configure user account sec urity , use t he following CLI command: (configure)# set login [atte mpts <num -l ogi n-att em pts> ] [tim e out- lim it <timeout -limit> ] [mi n-pa sswo rd-le ng th <min -pas swor d-le ngth > ] T o view the cur rent sett[...]
-
Page 68
2-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 10. Add User Acc ount W eb Page 4. In the User Name field, ent e r a unique user name. User names can consis t of a maximum of 31 cha r acters. 5. In the Password field, e nte r a pa s swo r d fo r the us er n ame. Pass wo rd s can cons ist of a maximum[...]
-
Page 69
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-21 Setting Up th e Switch 8. In the Expiration W arning (weeks ) field, enter the numb er of weeks before us er account expiration that you want the user wa rned. The expirat ion warning can range from 0 t o the expiration pe riod. A setting of 0 indi cates tha t no warning is gener ated. 9. In the Access T [...]
-
Page 70
2-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Modifying a Use r Account T o modify a us er account: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the System > Admini stra tio n fold ers . 2. Click User Account s . The User Account Management W eb page is displa yed in the conten t pane. See Figure 2-9 . 3. In t he [...]
-
Page 71
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-23 Setting Up th e Switch 6. T o change the number o f weeks for which t he user account i s valid, change the setting of the Expiration Period (weeks) field. The expirat i on period can ra nge from 3 to 999 week s. The default se tting is 0, no ex pi rati on. 7. T o ch ange the numbe r of weeks before user [...]
-
Page 72
2-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Changing Y o ur Password All user s can change thei r own passwords. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o change your passwor d: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the System folde r. 2. Click Chan ge Pas swor d . The Change Password W eb pa ge is dis played in the co[...]
-
Page 73
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-25 Setting Up th e Switch Disabling a Use r Account For secur ity r easons , you may want t o d isable c ertai n user acco unts, s uch as the manuf and diag acc ounts. Web A g e n t Procedure T o disa ble a us er ac co un t: 1. Exp and the System > Admini stration folders. 2. Clic k User Accounts . The Us[...]
-
Page 74
2-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 13. Delete Us er Account W eb Page 5. Click YES to dele te the user acc ount. CLI Command T o delete a user account, us e the following CLI comman d: (configure)# no user name <name > Changing the Co nsole Serial Port Settings Y ou can change the [...]
-
Page 75
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-27 Setting Up th e Switch Configurin g the Serial Console Port as a TTY Console Y ou can configu re the serial port as a TTY cons ole using eithe r the W eb Agent or th e CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o configure the con sol e serial port as a TTY Console using t he W eb Agent: 1. In the navi gation pane , [...]
-
Page 76
2-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 15. Console Por t Configuration W eb Page 3. See Ta b l e 2 - 4 and configure th e other Console Por t Configuratio n W eb page p ara m ete rs. 4. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to clear yo ur select ion. CLI Command T o configur e the co[...]
-
Page 77
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-29 Setting Up th e Switch Configuring the Serial Co nsole Port as a PPP Console Y ou can recon figure the seri al port as a PP P consol e to su pport a dial-in PPP connectio n using either t he W eb Agent or the C LI. Before you ca n do so, however , you must co nnect a modem to the s witch. * Note: If you d[...]
-
Page 78
2-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o confi gure the c onsole serial port as a PPP consol e from the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Syste m > C onf igur ation folde rs, and then c lick Console . The Consol e Configuration W eb page i s displayed [...]
-
Page 79
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-31 Setting Up th e Switch 5. Enter t he mode m initi ali zation comman d in t he Mo dem I nit Cm d field. The defaul t modem configurat ion init command is A T&D0SO=1. See Ta b l e 2 - 5 for a def i nition of the Modem Configur ation Init com mand pa ra me te rs. * Note: If you mis con fi gur e the PPP s[...]
-
Page 80
2-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Regaining Configuration Access to the PPP Serial Port Console If you i ncorrectly config ure the PPP seria l port console, y ou cannot regain configur ation access t o the W eb Agent or the CLI. This is a temporary situat ion and can corre cted. T o regain c onfi[...]
-
Page 81
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-33 Setting Up th e Switch 5. Open t he Select a Modem pull-down m enu. 6. Sele ct your modem and sele ct Configure . The Modem Pr oper ties window opens. 7. Sele ct the Connection tab . The Connection wind ow opens. 8. Sele ct the foll owing from the Connect ion Prefer ences window: — Open the Da ta bits p[...]
-
Page 82
2-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 24. Selec t OK to close th e TCP/IP window . 25. Selec t OK to close th e New Connections Pr operties window . Using Dial-Up Networkin g with a PPP Serial Port Conso le T o use TCP/IP a pplications (T elnet, HTTP , and SNMP) over y our PPP serial port interfa ce:[...]
-
Page 83
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-35 Setting Up th e Switch Chan gi ng th e T CP Ports for HTTP and T e ln e t Overview For securi ty purposes, you may want to change the TCP port number for T elnet requ ests and HTTP request s. The defaul t setti ngs for th ese ports ar e the well- known TCP ports . HTTP requests use TCP p ort 80, and T eln[...]
-
Page 84
2-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Figure 2- 18. TCP Port s W eb page 3. T o change the TCP port for T elnet re quests, in the Port Number field f or T elnet, en ter the port numbe r that you want t o use. V alid po rt numbers are 23 or a port number fr om 9000 through 65 355. The defa ult port fo[...]
-
Page 85
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-37 Setting Up th e Switch CLI Commands T o cha ng e th e TC P po rt fo r T e lnet req ue sts , use the f ollo win g CL I command: (configure)# ip telne t p or t <tcp-telnet -port> T o change the T C P port for HTTP re quests, use the f ollowing CLI command: (configure)# ip ht tp port <tcp-htt p-port[...]
-
Page 86
2-38 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Managin g Configuration Files When you fir st install t he swit ch, or u pgrade from a prev ious installa tion, your conf iguration para m eters are stored in a start up.txt file loca ted in the switch’ s Non-V olatile Random Access Memory (NVRAM). Wh en the sw[...]
-
Page 87
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-39 Setting Up th e Switch Viewing the Runn ing Config uration Y ou must have admin istrator acce ss to vie w the running c onfiguration. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view the running co nfiguratio n: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Syst em > Configuration > Configurat ion Fil es fol der s. 2. C[...]
-
Page 88
2-40 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Copying Con figuration F iles Y ou must have ad m inist rator ac cess to copy the c onfiguration f iles. If you make any changes, yo u must save t he running confi guration as the startu p configuration to save the chang es. Before you d o this, always cop y your[...]
-
Page 89
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-41 Setting Up th e Switch Figure 2-19. Configuration Fil e Management W eb Page 2. Clic k Save . The runnin g configuration is saved as the startup configur ation. * Note: Y ou can a lso save the run ning configur ation to the st artup configur ation through the Configur ation File Management W eb page. See [...]
-
Page 90
2-42 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 Copying Files Y ou must have ad m inistrat or access to copy t ext files and BOOT , APP1, and APP2 image s. Y o u ca n copy fil es to and fr om m ult iple lo cat ion s. For e xam pl e , if y o u modify th e running conf iguratio n and you want to reinsta te your [...]
-
Page 91
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-43 Setting Up th e Switch — File — T o copy a file stored o n the swit ch to your running or start up configurat ion, to a locat ion on the switch , or to a locati on on a TFTP se rver . — TFTP Server — T o copy a fi le stored on a TF TP server t o your running or startup conf iguration or t o a file[...]
-
Page 92
2-44 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2 — TFTP Server — Copie s your startup o r running config uration, or anothe r file located on the switch, to a l ocation on a T FTP server . *Note: If you select Fil e or TFTP Server , you must al so provide the path a nd filename of th e destination f ile in [...]
-
Page 93
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 2-45 Setting Up th e Switch Viewing the S t atus of a TFTP T ransfer After you h ave copied the startup configuration or other files to a TFTP server , you can use ei ther the W eb Agent or the CLI to ch eck the st atus of the TFTP tra nsfer to ens ure that files copie d correctly . Web A g e n t Procedure T o[...]
-
Page 94
2-46 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 2[...]
-
Page 95
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 3-1 3 Configuring Sys tem Information Ove rview Y ou can manage sys t em information by using eit her the W eb Agent or t he CLI. The foll owing procedures to manage your syst em information are prov ide d in th is c ha pte r: ■ Ente ring G en er al S ystem In fo rmat ion ■[...]
-
Page 96
3-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 3 Entering General Sys tem Informati on Y ou can enter general infor m ation a bout your s ystem by using eit her the W eb Agent or the CLI . We b A g e n t Proc edu re Y o u ca n ente r ge nera l syst em in for matio n u si ng t he fo llo w ing W eb Ag en t fiel [...]
-
Page 97
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-3 Configuring System Informati on 4. Enter the person who sho uld be contacted in the event o f a probl em in the Con tact fie ld. 5. Clic k APPL Y to sa ve your cha nges, or CANCEL to clear your selectio n. Enabling the Simp le Network T ime Protocol Y ou can enable Simpl e Network T ime Protocol (SNTP) on [...]
-
Page 98
3-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 3 2. Select Simple Network T ime Protocol (SNTP) from the Clo ck Options box. The SNTP Clie nt Configuratio n W eb page is displ ayed in the cont ent pane. Se e Figure 3-3 . Figure 3- 3. SNTP Client Co nfiguration W eb Page 3. Select Enable from the Enable S tate [...]
-
Page 99
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-5 Configuring System Informati on Setting Summer T ime Hours Summer T ime Hours, al so refer r ed to as Daylig ht Savings Time (DST) , is the stra tegy of moving cloc ks ahead to provi de greater amount s of daylight in the af ternoon and to standardize t ime with other parts of the world. In man y pa r ts o[...]
-
Page 100
3-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 3 Figure 3- 4. System Clock W eb Page 2. Select Summer T ime Hours Algori thm from t he Clock Options field . The Summer T ime Hours Configurat ion W eb page is displayed in the content pane. See Figure 3 -5 .[...]
-
Page 101
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-7 Configuring System Informati on Figure 3-5. Summ er T ime Hours W eb Page 3. Se lect En a b le from t he Enable S tate pull- down menu. 4. Enter th e re s et va lue for t he cl o ck i n min ute s in the Offset field. For example , if yo u intend t o reset the c lock forwa rd or backward by one hour , keep [...]
-
Page 102
3-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 3 See Ta b l e 3 - 1 for deta ile d i nfo rm at io n ab o ut th e fiel ds in the R ecu rr ing Summer T ime Hours sect ion of the Summer T ime Hours Co nfiguration W eb page . T able 3-1. Recurring Summer T i me Hours Parameters Parameter Defini tio n Recurring Sel[...]
-
Page 103
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-9 Configuring System Informati on CLI Command T o se t r ecu rrin g Sum mer Time Hour s us in g th e CLI , ent er th e fo llow i ng command from Conf igure mode: (configure)# clock su mm er-time recur rin g <week> Day Select the day of the week when you want recurr i ng Summer T ime Hours to start o r [...]
-
Page 104
3-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 3 Setting One -Time Summer Time Hours Y ou can set one-time su mmer time h ours using eit her the W e b Agent or the CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o s et S um mer Time Hour s th at ar e no t ba se d on a st anda rd ru le u sin g t he We b A g e n t : 1. In the [...]
-
Page 105
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-11 Configuring System Informati on CLI Command T o set Summer T ime Hours that are not ba sed on a standard rule using t he CLI, enter t he following command from Configure mode: (configure)# clock su mm er-time da te Setting t he System Clock The system cl ock is used for setting traps , alarms , and other [...]
-
Page 106
3-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 3 Figure 3- 6. System Clock W eb Page 2. Ent er th e time in the C urrent Time Sett ing Hour , Minutes, an d Second s fields us ing 24-hour time for mat (for exampl e, 10 p.m. is 22 :00 00. 3. Select the t ime zone fo r your area from t he Tim e Z on e pull-d own m[...]
-
Page 107
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-13 Configuring System Informati on Setting t he T emperatu re System Y ou can set the upper and lower temperatur e warning systems fo r the switch backplane an d slot 1. The se warni ng syste ms caus e the fol lowing to happen if the t emperatures you se t are reach ed: ■ Shutdown T emperatur e— The swit[...]
-
Page 108
3-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 3 2. In the Slot 1 Senso r and Backpla ne Sensor fields, ent er the des ired temp er atu re wa rnin gs. * Note: The P882 does not di splay the curr ent temperatu re of the backpla ne. In the Current T emperatur e fiel d, t he s witch disp lay s -- . * Note: If a re[...]
-
Page 109
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-15 Configuring System Informati on Displayi ng the Power System S t atis ti cs Y ou can disp lay th e stat istics for yo ur switc h’ s power s ystem fro m the either the W eb Agent and the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o disp lay y our swi tc h’ s po we r s yst em st atis tics usi ng t he W e b Age nt: [...]
-
Page 110
3-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 3 two of t he three power supp lies. The third power supply is a redunda nt power supply and is use d only if one of t he other power sup plies fail s. CLI Command T o display your switch’ s power system st atistics usi ng the CLI, ente r the followi ng command f[...]
-
Page 111
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 3-17 Configuring System Informati on Figure 3-10. P882 Cooling System S tatus W eb Page 2. Check t he S ta tus c olumn to e nsure that all the i ndivi dual c omponents a re operati onal. 3. If a component’ s stat us is non-operat ional, powe r down the switch a nd contact a service re presentati ve to diag n[...]
-
Page 112
3-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 3 Figure 3- 1 1. System Reset Page W eb Page 2. Select Save t o save your Running Con f iguration (Runn ing-Config to the startup configuration (S tartup-Confi g before perfor ming a system rese t. *Note: If you do not save your Runni ng-Config to S tartup-Con fig [...]
-
Page 113
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 4-1 4 Security Ove rview This chapt er contains the following to pics: ■ Secure Mode ■ SSHv2 ■ HTTPS Using SSLv3 or TLSv1 ■ RADIUS Client Support For more informa tion about the CLI comman ds that are menti oned in this chapter , see Comman d Refer ence Guide for the A [...]
-
Page 114
4-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 4 When secure mode is ena ble d: ■ All non-se cure protocols, such as T elne t , HTTP , and SNMPv1 and v2 are aut omatically disa bled. ■ Y ou cannot use I P to manage the sta ndby supervisor m odule. Any IP inter fac es that you co nfi gur ed to access the re[...]
-
Page 115
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-3 Security Enabling Secure Mo de T o enable secure mode, use the followin g CLI command : (configure)# secur e-mode Disabling Secu re Mode T o disable s ecure mode, us e the following CLI command: (configure)# no sec u re-mo d e Viewing the Secure Mode Setting T o view the se cure mode setting , use the f ol[...]
-
Page 116
4-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 4 Encryption Ciphers The A vaya Multis ervice swi t ch supports Blo wfish and 3DES enc ryption ciphers . When the client c onnects to the ho st, the client supplies a lis t of ciphers that it sup ports. The s erver selects the strongest common cipher . Y ou can al[...]
-
Page 117
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-5 Security Figure 4-1. TCP Ports W eb Page 3. In the St a t e fi eld for T elnet, se lect Disable . 4. In the Port Number field f or SSH, ente r the port number y ou want to use for SS H . V alid SSH ports are 22 and 9000 to 6 5,535. The default port for SSH is port 22. 5. In the St a t e field fo r SS H , s[...]
-
Page 118
4-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 4 CLI Command T o disable SSH, use the following CLI command: (configure)# no ip s sh Generating an SSH Server Key The A vay a Multiservi ce switch currently supports RSA and DSA key t ypes. Y ou can specify t he key len gth of 768, 102 4, or 2048 byt es. A key of[...]
-
Page 119
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-7 Security CLI Command T o generate SSH key pairs and save t hem on the local se rver , use the following CLI command: (configure)# ssh k eygen [{rsa | dsa}] [ke y-size {768 | 1024 | 2048}] Displaying the Pub lic SSH Key The SSH Server Key is sent to th e client in an SSH c onnectio n. T o display t he publi[...]
-
Page 120
4-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 4 Figure 4- 3. SSH Configurat ion W eb Page 3. In the Server Idle Timeou t f ield, spe cify the time out on a con nection. V alid r ange is 0 to 1800 s econds. The defa ult is 60 0 seconds. 4. Click Apply . CLI Commands T o configure SSH, use the following CLI c o[...]
-
Page 121
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-9 Security Displaying SSH Co nnections CLI Command T o di spl ay cur ren t S SH s essi ons , use the fo llow in g CLI c om m and : # show ssh se ssi ons T o end an SSH sess ion, use the fol lowing CLI comman d: (configure)# clear ss h <session-id> This funct ionality is a vailable only i n the CLI. Y o[...]
-
Page 122
4-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 HTTPS Using SSLv3 or TLSv1 Overview The A vaya P580 and P882 Multiservi ce switches supp ort Secure Socket Layer , ver sion 3 (SSLv3 ), and T ransport Layer Se curity , version 1.0 (TLSv1). SSL and TLS ar e protocols that provide data s ecurity b etween applicat [...]
-
Page 123
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-11 Security This sect ion contains the foll owing informat ion and procedu res: ■ Supporte d Cipher Suites ■ V iewing Cipher Su ites ■ V iewing the SSL Conf igurati on ■ Creatin g a Self-Sign ed SSL Server Certificate ■ V i ewin g th e S erv e r Ce rt ific ate ■ Enabling SSL/HTTPS ■ Restartin g[...]
-
Page 124
4-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 V iewing Cipher Suites We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o view av ailable cipher suites: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expand t he System > Administrat ion > Secur i ty > SSL fol ders. 2. Click Ciphers . Th e SSL Ciphers W eb page is dis played in the con tent[...]
-
Page 125
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-13 Security Creating a Self-Signed SSL Server Certificate Overview A sel f-signed ce rtific ate is a ce rtif ic ate for wh ich the is sue r is t he same as the subje ct (the entit y whose public k ey is bein g authenticate d by the certifi cate). T o crea te a self-sig ned certifica te, you must fi rst comp [...]
-
Page 126
4-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 Figure 4- 5. SSL Server Certif icate Reque st W eb Page 4. Enter the app ropriate infor mation in the following fi elds: ■ Key T yp e —RSA only . ■ Key L e n g th —Select t he l ength of the key . Opti ons are 512 or 1 024 bits. ■ T wo-digit Count ry Co[...]
-
Page 127
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-15 Security 5. Clic k Crea te Sel f-S igned Cer tific a te . 6. Rest art SSL for the n ew certi fica te t o ta ke effect. Fo r in form atio n on ho w to rest art SSL, see “ Resta r ting SSL/HTTPS ” late r in this chapt er . CLI Command T o cr ea te a self -sig n ed c erti fica t e, u se the foll o win g [...]
-
Page 128
4-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 Figure 4- 6. SSL Server Certif icate W e b Page CLI Command T o view the SSL certificate , use the followi ng CLI command: > show ssl ce rt[...]
-
Page 129
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-17 Security Enabling SSL/HTTPS Before you c an enable SSL/HTTPS on the swit ch, you must disabl e HTTP . Web A g e n t Procedure T o enable SSL/HTTPS : 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Syst em > Administratio n folders. 2. Clic k TCP Ports . The TCP Ports W eb page is d isplayed in the content pan[...]
-
Page 130
4-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 Rest arting SSL/HT TPS Y ou must rest art SSL after upda ting the certi ficate infor mation. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o rest art SSL: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expand t he System > Administrat ion > Secur i ty > SSL fol ders. 2. Click Configura t i[...]
-
Page 131
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-19 Security RADIUS Client Support Overview Purpose of RADIUS In a network wit h man y A vaya switches , con fi gur ing use r accounts on eac h of the switch es can be time -consuming .Y ou can centrali ze the use r accounts by using a Re m ote Authentic ation Dial-In Us er Service ( RADIUS) server . RADIUS i[...]
-
Page 132
4-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 This inter ope rab ility issue occurs beca use Micr osof t RADIUS server includes a cl ass attr ibute in Acce ss-Accept messages that the P580 a nd P882 RADIUS client do es not support. W ith servic e pack 3, you can disable generat ion of a c lass attribut e. Fo[...]
-
Page 133
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-21 Security Similarl y , when the sa me user logs in to a switch on the Sou th campus, the message will appen d @A vayaRealm and a g roup name of Sout hSwitches . The RADIUS serve r will send an Acce ss-Accept message indicat ing that the user h as read-only permission. Realms A realm provide s a mechanism b[...]
-
Page 134
4-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 If the u s er login is i ncorrect or does not exist, then the RADIUS serv er sends an Access-Reject message to t he switch and the user is denied access to the swi tc h. If the prim ar y R AD IUS s erve r do e s no t res pon d to th e Ac cess - Req ues t mess age[...]
-
Page 135
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-23 Security For example, to give a user access to modules and ports , event management, layer 2 swi tching, and rout ing, you would enter a hexadecimal val ue of 08888000 (000 0 1000 1000 1000 100 0 0000 0000 0000 binar y). * Note: Only bits 12, 16, 20, 2 4, and 28 are used i n the CA T access mask. Set al l[...]
-
Page 136
4-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 RADIUS Server Files Each RADIUS vend or may have a dif ferent method for configuring client and user files. For info rmation on conf iguring t he client and us er files on your RADIUS ser v er , see the RADIUS server do cumentation. The followi ng tables list the[...]
-
Page 137
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-25 Security Sample User File The following is a sample user file. Ea ch RADIUS vendor may have a dif ferent method for configuring use r files. In th is sample, text v alues are defined t hat represent the actual valu es used by the A vaya switch u sing the directives A TTRIBUTE and V ALUE. T wo user ac coun[...]
-
Page 138
4-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 Configuring a RAD IUS Client We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o configur e a RADIUS client: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the System > Admini stra tio n fold ers , and then click RADIUS . The RADIUS W e b page is displ ayed in the content pane ( Figure 4-7 )[...]
-
Page 139
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-27 Security T ab le 4-4. RADIUS W eb Page Configurat ion Paramete rs Parameter Defi nition Enable S tate Enable or disable RADIUS on the switch. Primary Server • IP Address - Enter the IP address for t he primary RADIUS server . • Shared Secr et - Enter the s hared secret the switch will use for encrypt [...]
-
Page 140
4-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4 CLI Command Use the f ollowing CLI commands t o configure the R ADIUS client on the switc h: ■ T o enable or d isable RADIUS clien t , (configure)# set radi us authentica tion [{enabled | d i sabled}] ■ T o assi gn t h e sw it ch to a gr ou p, (configure)# se[...]
-
Page 141
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 4-29 Security ■ T o set the IP address use d as the s ource IP address for Access- Requ est me ss age s, (configure)# s e t rad i us a u the n tica tio n sour ce-ip <ip-add r> ■ T o set whether the swit ch r eco gnizes only Acces s- Accep t messages that ha ve the correct g r oup name included, (conf[...]
-
Page 142
4-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 4[...]
-
Page 143
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 5-1 5 Configur ing SNMP Ove rview Supported versions of SNMP The P580 and P88 2 support SNMPv1, v2, and v 3. SNMPv3 S ecurity Features SNMP version 3 pr ovi des t he fol l owing security fea tures that SNMPv1 and v2 do not pr ovide: ■ Encrypti on of protocol da ta units (PDUs[...]
-
Page 144
5-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 5 ■ Creating a n SNMPv3 Administrator ■ Configuri ng V iews ■ Configuri ng Groups ■ Configuri ng an SNMPv3 Use r ■ Changing a Use r Password ■ Configuri ng SNMPv1 or v2 Communit y Strings ■ Setting t he Admini strative Conta ct ■ Sett ing th e Ph y[...]
-
Page 145
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-3 Configu ring SNMP Authentic ation and Encr yption Localized Keys T o perform aut henticat ion and encry ption, the switch and NMS (networ k man age men t sy stem ) sha re loc aliz ed keys . When sen ding a PDU to the switch, the NMS (network mana gement syst em) generates the local ized key and places it i[...]
-
Page 146
5-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 5 T imeliness Chec ks The s wit ch pe rfo rm s tim elin ess ch eck s to e nsu re tha t PD U s ar e not reorder e d, delayed or re played. These timel iness checks i nclude the followi ng informatio n: ■ Number of reb oots since the s witch was upgrad ed from v5.[...]
-
Page 147
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-5 Configu ring SNMP Predefined V iews When you upg rade the switch f r om v5. x applicat ion software to v6. x , the follow ing pred efined v iews are crea ted: ■ normal —In cludes the MIB ob jects that the norm al secu rity le vel include d. The view includes all the support ed MIBs except t hose object[...]
-
Page 148
5-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 5 CAUTION: This sect ion co nta i ns th e fo ll ow ing in for matio n: ■ Predefine d Groups ■ Migration of Existing Community Strings For info rmation on how to configur e groups, see “ Configur ing Groups .” Predefined Group s When you upgr ade the switch[...]
-
Page 149
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-7 Configu ring SNMP Ta b l e 5 - 1 lists all th e predefined vie ws, groups, and us ers. Migration of Existing Comm unity Strings When you upg rade the switch f r om v5. x applicat ion software to v6. x , the existing community strings are assi gned to either a predefined grou p or , if previousl y assigned [...]
-
Page 150
5-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 5 Ta b l e 5 - 2 lists the grou ps to which exist i ng communi ty st ri ngs are assi gne d when you upgr ade the switch f rom v5. x appli ca tio n soft wa re to v6 . x . A TM Uplink Mo dule Over view The A TM Uplink module supports only SNMPv1 a nd v2. It doe s no[...]
-
Page 151
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-9 Configu ring SNMP Process The p roxy forwarder pr ocess is as fol lows: 1. An NMS prepa r es an SNMPv3 request PDU. This PDU contain s the switch sec urity creden tials, includi ng the engine ID and context name of the A TM Uplink module. 2. The supe rviso r modules rece ive s the PDU from th e NMS. It ver[...]
-
Page 152
5-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 CAUTION: SNMP v3 Administrator After either manuall y assigning the s witch an engine I D or assigning the console port an IP addres s, you can crea te an SNMPv3 admin istrator . This administ rator will be a ble to create a nd modify SNMPv3 user s by using SNMP [...]
-
Page 153
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-11 Configu ring SNMP CAUTION: Viewing the Engine ID T o view th e c urr ently configur ed engine ID o f t he swi tc h, us e the following CLI comm an d : (configure)# show sn m p en gin e id Creating an SNMPv3 Administrat or After eit her manually ass igning the switc h an engine ID or as signing the console[...]
-
Page 154
5-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 Config u r in g Views This sec tion contains pr ocedures for th e following tas ks: ■ Creating o r Modifying a V iew ■ V iewing Configure d V iews ■ Deleting a V iew Creating or Modifying a V i ew T o create o r modify a MIB view , use the followi ng CLI co[...]
-
Page 155
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-13 Configu ring SNMP Viewing Configu red Views T o view the current l y configured vi ews, use the foll owing CLI command: # show snmp vi ew [ <vie wname> ] Deleting a View T o delete a v i ew or remove an OID from a view , use the followi ng CLI command: (configure)# no snmp- server view <viewname&[...]
-
Page 156
5-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 CAUTION: Creating or Modif ying a G roup T o create o r modify a group, us e the fol l owing CLI command: (configure)# snmp-se r ver group <g roupname> {noAuth | aut h | priv} [r ead <rea dview > ] [write <wr iteview> ] [ not if y <notif yvie[...]
-
Page 157
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-15 Configu ring SNMP Deleting a Group T o delete a specifi c group or a ll groups o f a spec ific gro up name (if mul tiple groups have the same group n ame), use t he following CLI comman d: (configure)# no snmp-se rver g r oup <group name> {noAuth | auth | priv} If multip le groups have th e same gro[...]
-
Page 158
5-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 Adding a User to a Group T o add an SNMPv3 user to a group, u se the fol l owing CLI command: (configure)# snmp -s erv er us er < user nam e> group <groupname> T able 5-7. snmp-serv er user Command Parameter Def inition <username> User name for [...]
-
Page 159
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-17 Configu ring SNMP Removing a User from a Group T o remove an SNMPv 3 user fro m a group, use the followin g CLI command: (configure)# no snmp- server user <use rname> gr oup <groupname> Viewing Configu red Use rs T o view the cur rently configu r ed SNMPv3 users, us e the fol l owing CLI comma[...]
-
Page 160
5-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 Changing a User Password Y ou must change user passwords when the engine ID chan ges. T o change a us er password, use t he following CLI c o mm and: (configure)# snmp -s erv er pa ssw ord <user name> The switc h prompts you to enter the new p assword or pa[...]
-
Page 161
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-19 Configu ring SNMP Ta b l e 5 - 8 defines the command keywords and varia bles. Creating or Modifyin g a Community S t ring for the A TM- Uplink Modu le T o create or modi fy a co m munit y s tr ing to acc ess the A TM-Uplink mod ule , use the fo llowing CLI comm and: (configure)# snmp-s erver atm-communit [...]
-
Page 162
5-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 V iewing Configured Communit y S t rings T o view th e cu rr ent ly configure d co mmun it y strings, use th e fo ll owing CLI command: # show sn mp co mm uni ty [ <co mm unity -str ing> ] Setting the T rap Receiver T o s et th e trap rece i ver for a comm [...]
-
Page 163
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-21 Configu ring SNMP A TM Module Community String T o delete a com m unity s tring for the A TM-Upli nk module , use the follow ing command : (configure)# no snmp-server at m-community <communi ty-string> [ <ip-addr> ] Ta b l e 5 - 1 2 provides an explana tion of the command variables. Setting t [...]
-
Page 164
5-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5 SNMP T o set the admin istrative con t act for the swi t ch, use the sys C ontact object, OID 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.4. The compl ete path to this obje ct is: iso(1) .org( 3).dod(6).inter net(1).mgmt(2).mib-2( 1).system(1). sysContac t(4) Settin g the Physical Locat ion o[...]
-
Page 165
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 5-23 Configu ring SNMP Disabling or Reenabling SNMP Disabling SNMP T o disable SNMP , use the follo wing CLI command: (configure)# no snmp- server This command overr ides se cure mode, whi ch disabl es SNMPv1 and v2 and enables SNMPv3. For information on secure mode , see “ Secure Mode .” Reenabl ing SNMP [...]
-
Page 166
5-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 5[...]
-
Page 167
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 6-1 6 Using VLANs, Hunt Group s, and VTP Snooping Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es are pr ovided in this c hapter and pertain t o layer 2 and layer 3 modu le configurati ons: ■ VLAN Introduc tion ■ Creatin g and Implementing VLANs ■ Using Hunt Groups [...]
-
Page 168
6-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 6 Advantage s with VLANs: ■ Segment tra ffic and u sage pattern s in a ma nner simil ar to creatin g subnets an d segments in tra ditional networ ks. ■ Reduce the c ost of equipment mov es, upgrades, and ot her chang es. ■ Simplify ne twork administra tion. [...]
-
Page 169
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-3 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping A switch tha t is strictl y port based needs addi tional info rmatio n to sep arate traf f ic passing fr om one VLAN t o an oth er . Since ea ch p ort is dedicated to a particul ar VLAN, th ere is no need to analyz e the t raf fi c arr iving on a port to dete rm[...]
-
Page 170
6-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 6 IEEE 8 02.1Q VLAN T agging The A vaya Multiservi ce switch is co mpliant wi th the I EEE 802.1Q sta ndard for VLANs and defines a T ag Header . T wo T ag format s are defined as an Ethernet Encoded (4 bytes) for 802.3 and Ethe rnet V2 and SNAP (Servi ce Network [...]
-
Page 171
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-5 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Forwar ding Rule s These rul es dete rmine t he set of port s on the swit ch throug h which m embers of the VLAN can be reached. This i s called bin ding a port to a VLAN. A port may be b ound to a VLAN using the W eb Agent in the fo llowing three ways: 1. Se tt[...]
-
Page 172
6-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 6 CAUTION: Forwarding : Only forward frames to the por t for the assigned VLAN. Egress : All fr ames tr ansmitted out of the port t o be tagged usi ng the IEEE 802.1Q/Mu lti-Laye r tag header format. The t agged used wil l be that assigned to the port. Binding a P[...]
-
Page 173
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-7 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping CAUTION: Creating and Implementing VLANs Adding user s to VLANs include: ■ VLAN Considera tions ■ Creatin g a VLAN ■ Configur ing VLAN Parameters ■ Assignin g Ports to VLANs VLAN Consid erations Be aware of t he following is sues when configur ing VLANs:[...]
-
Page 174
6-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 6 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o create a VLAN: 1. In the navi ga ti on pa ne, expand the L2 Switchin g > VLANs fold ers , and then c lick Configurat ion . The VLAN Config uration W eb page i s displayed in t he content pane. See Figur e 6-3 . Figure 6- 3. VLAN[...]
-
Page 175
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-9 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Figure 6-4. Create VLAN W eb Page 3. Enter a name for the VLAN in the Name fi el d. 4. In t he ID field, ente r an unused VLAN ID va lue (betwe en 2 to 4094). VLAN IDs are gl obal and must be con sistent from switc h to switch , even when swi t ches are manufac [...]
-
Page 176
6-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 CAUTION: 6. Click APPL Y to create the new VLAN, or CANCEL to restor e previous settin gs. Before confi guri ng Hash T ables and Auto Incr ement Hash T able paramet ers, Avaya strongl y recommends that you review the content s of Chapter 9 , “ Managing t he Add[...]
-
Page 177
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-11 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Figure 6-5. V LAN Switch Por ts W eb Page 3. See Ta b l e 6 - 2 to confi gure the VLAN Swit ch Ports W eb page para mete rs: T ab le 6-2. VLAN Swit ch Port W eb Page Para meters Parameter Defin es... Port The switch port associated with the VLAN. Name The switc[...]
-
Page 178
6-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 4. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to rest ore previous settin gs. Binding T y pe The binding types are set through the switch ports. See “ Assigning VLANs to a Port and As s ociated Issues ” in Chapt er 8 , “ Configuring P orts .” • St a [...]
-
Page 179
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-13 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping CAUTION: Assigning Port s t o VLANs See “ Config uring Switch Ports Set tings ,” in Chapter 8 , “ Configurin g Ports , ” for instr uctions on assigning por ts to VLANs. Before changing the VLAN that a port is assigned t o, you m ust remove the port from[...]
-
Page 180
6-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Hunt group s expand the ca pacity of the core switch ed backbone. While there i s no specific limi t on the number of p orts in a hunt gr oup (see “ Hu nt Group Confi guration Conside rations ”). I n the example, the hunt group consist s of two full-du plex G[...]
-
Page 181
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-15 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping ■ Quicker re covery from lin k failure — If a port in the group fails , the remainin g ports carry the loa d. Recover y is no t limit ed by Spa nning T ree Protoc ol conver gence time ( converge nce time i s the time the network t akes to resume st eady-sta[...]
-
Page 182
6-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 80-Ser ies Forwarding Engines The Forwar di ng Engines ar e number ed st arting at one and incre ase d b y on e for eac h Forwarding Engine. The Supervisor modul e always has Forwardin g Engines numbere d one an d two. For a 7- slot P580 switch , numbers one and [...]
-
Page 183
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-17 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping This is dif fer ent for the 50-serie s modules. The twe lve port la yer 3 50-serie s media module, all twelve po rts are a ssociated with one Forwarding Engin e for layer 3 tr affic and one Forwarding Engin e fo r la yer 2 traf f ic . In a ddition only one fa b[...]
-
Page 184
6-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Figure 6- 7. Slot to Fabric Po rt Rela tionship T able 6-3. Module Forwarding Engines and Fa bric Port s Module T ype T otal Nu mb er o f forwarding engines Number of Fabric Port s Description 80-serie s M8000R Supervisor 2 1 FORE por t, CPU 80-se rie s 24 port 1[...]
-
Page 185
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-19 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping * Note: All 80-series med ia modules are L3 capable . Figure 6-8. Load Sharing Example Optimiz ing Hun t Group T hrough put T o optimiz e hunt grou p throughput f ollow these consi derations. ■ Forwardi ng Engines i n the hunt group po rts shoul d be separa t[...]
-
Page 186
6-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Hunt Group Co nfiguration Consideration s Consider the followin g before c reating hunt gro ups: ■ Hunt group e nd to end physic al connec tions must be c onfigured with the hu nt group ports co nnected to hunt gr oup ports. ■ All ports of the hunt group m us[...]
-
Page 187
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-21 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Hunt Group s and Multicast T raffic All multic ast traf fic is forwarde d by the base port of the hunt g r oup. If the base po rt c han ges, mult ica st tr affic is in terr upted un ti l the ses si ons are relearne d through t he new base port. T o decrea se or[...]
-
Page 188
6-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Figure 6- 9. Hunt Group Confi guration W eb Page 2. Click CREA TE . The Create Hunt Group W eb page is displ ayed in the content pane. See Figure 6 -10 . Figure 6- 10. Create Hunt Group W eb Page 3. In the Name field, enter a name for the h unt group. This fi eld[...]
-
Page 189
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-23 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping CLI Commands Use the fol lowing CLI commands to configure a hu nt group: ■ T o create a hunt group, ( configure)# s et huntgroup <huntgroup-n ame> [load-sharing {ena ble | disabl e}] ■ T o e nable or d isa ble t he au to fl ush fe atu re fo r the p or[...]
-
Page 190
6-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 2. Select a port number from the Ports col umn. The Physic al Port Configur ation W eb page is displayed in the content pane. See Figure 6- 12 . Figure 6- 12. Physical Port Configuration W eb Pag e 3. Uncheck the che c kbox from the Enable c olum n fo r a sp ecif[...]
-
Page 191
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-25 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Adding Switch Port s to the Hunt Group 1. Sele ct Modules at the bo ttom of the Physic al Port Configur ation W eb page. The Modul e Information W eb page is re displayed. See Fi gure 6- 11 . As an alte rnate procedure , expand the Modules & Ports fo lder ,[...]
-
Page 192
6-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Figure 6- 14. Switch Por t Configurati on W eb Page 4. Select the hu nt group assignmen t from the Hun t Gr oup pull-down menu. 5. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs.[...]
-
Page 193
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-27 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping 6. Rep eat S teps 1-9 for any additional ports that you want to a dd to this hunt group . 7. Rep eat step s 1 through 10 on th e switch at the o ther end of the hu nt group conne ction. 8. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Modules & Ports folder , and t[...]
-
Page 194
6-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 Figure 6- 15. Hunt Group Member s W eb Page CLI Commands T o view details ab out hunt group member s using the CLI, enter th e followi ng command in configur ation mode: (configure)# show huntg roup <huntgroup- name> T o add por ts to a hu nt group using th[...]
-
Page 195
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-29 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping Configuring VTP Snooping Enabling VLAN T runk Prot ocol (VTP®) Snoopi ng on the A vaya Multise rvice switch al lows it to automa tically synchr onize its VLAN configura tion with that of a Cisco VTP server switch. VTP is a Cisco® layer 2 pr otocol used to mai[...]
-
Page 196
6-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o confi gure VTP snoop ing using the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Modules & Ports folder, and th en click Configuration . The Module Infor mation W eb page is displ ayed in the cont ent pane. See F igure 6-1[...]
-
Page 197
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 6-31 Using VL ANs, Hunt Groups , and VTP Snooping 9. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. CLI Command T o configure VTP snooping using the CLI , ente r the fol lowing co mmand in Con fig ure mo de: (configure)# set vtp-snooping en able T ab le 6-4. VTP Snoo ping Par[...]
-
Page 198
6-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 6[...]
-
Page 199
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 7-1 7 Configuring Ra pid S p anning T ree Ove rview Contents This chapter contains the fo llowing secti ons: ■ How RSTP Achieve s Rapid Recovery ■ Spanning T ree Configura tions ■ Configur ing Global Spanning Tr ee Options ■ V iewing Global Sp anning T ree Informatio n [...]
-
Page 200
7-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 7 In STP , a po rt that is blocki ng must change to li stening and then learnin g before i t can chan ge to forwa rding. Norm ally , a port remains in the li stening state fo r 15 second s and in the learni ng stat e for 15 sec onds. W ith these two 15-secon d del[...]
-
Page 201
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-3 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree How RSTP Achieves Rapid Recovery Port Roles In addit ion to por t stat es, RSTP assi gns an d maintain s port r oles for all por ts in a Spanni ng Tr ee domain. One of five possibl e roles can be a ssigned to a port: ro ot, designated, a lternate, backu p, and disabled. Ro[...]
-
Page 202
7-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 7 IEEE S ta ndards For more de tailed informati on about the STP and RSTP , see the I EEE 802.1D stan dard for Media Acce ss Control (MAC) bridges and IEEE802.1w amen dment for rapid r econfiguration . S p anning T ree Co nfigur ations The A vaya Multis ervice swi[...]
-
Page 203
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-5 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Per-VL AN Sp anning T ree Per-VLAN mode i s the Default Sp anning T ree settin g on all mul tiservice switches. I n this mode, t he swit ch runs a separ ate spa nning pr ocess for eac h VLAN. Each log ical Spann ing T ree has i ts own BPDUs which are t agged with the a ppr[...]
-
Page 204
7-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 7 In this mode, l egacy b ri dges re main in sep arate Spannin g T ree d omains, ye t loops bet w een the la yer 3 and legacy domai ns c anno t f orm. Fo r example; if there a re t hr ee P580 s w it che s i n a n et work runn ing VLAN A and VLAN B, and th re e le [...]
-
Page 205
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-7 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Configuring Globa l Sp anning T ree Options Overview Glob al spanning t r ee options incl ude the configur ation and ver sion of spanning t r ee (common STP or Rapid Span ning T ree). Web A g e n t Procedure T o configure global spanni ng tree o ptions on the swit ch: 1. I[...]
-
Page 206
7-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 7 4. In the Protocol V ersion fie ld, cl ick the ve rsion of Spann ing T ree that you want t he switch to run. 5. Click APPL Y to save your ch anges or CANCEL to res tore the previ ous settin gs. T able 7-1. Spanning T ree Informatio n Configuration Option Defi ni[...]
-
Page 207
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-9 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree CLI Command Use the follo wing CLI c ommands to configure global Spanning T ree options: ■ T o set the type of spanning t r ee that you want the swit ch to run, (configure)# set spantr ee config {ieee | per -vlan | dual-lay er | disable} ■ T o set the version of spanni[...]
-
Page 208
7-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 V iewing Global S p anning T r ee Inf ormation We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o view globa l spanning tree information: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the L2 Switching folder . 2. Click Spanning T ree . The Spanni ng T ree Informat ion W eb page is dis played [...]
-
Page 209
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-11 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Configuring S p anning T ree Bridges Web A g e n t Procedure T o config ure a spann ing tree bri dge: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the L2 Switchin g folder . 2. Clic k Spanning T re e . The S pann ing Tree Infor mat ion W eb pa ge is dis p laye d in th e co nte n [...]
-
Page 210
7-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 Priority Priority of the bridge as hexidecimal v a lu e. The valid ran ge for this field i s 0x00 00 (0) to 0xF000 (61,440) i n increm ents of 0x10 00 (4,096). The defau lt setting is 0x8000 (32,768). Note: When yo u upgrade the switc h from v5.x application soft[...]
-
Page 211
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-13 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree * Note: T h e A v aya Mu ltis erv ic e swi tche s enfo r ce th e foll owin g relati onships, as defi ned by IEEE 802.1D: — 2 × ( Bridge Forward Dela y – 1 second) > Bridge Max Age — Bridge Max Age > 2 × ( Bri dge H ell o Time + 1 second) 5. Clic k APPL Y to [...]
-
Page 212
7-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 ■ T o set the maximum age f or the bridge, (configure)# set spantr ee maxage <maxage-value > {802.1D | vlan { <v lan -id> | name <vlan-name> }} ■ T o set the he llo tim e for the brid ge, (configure)# set sp antree hello <hel lotim e-v al[...]
-
Page 213
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-15 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Figure 7-4. Spanning T ree Bridge Port Inf ormation W eb Pag e T able 7-4. Spanning T ree Bridg e Port Information Field Explanat ion Bridge P ort Bridge p ort number . Port Physical port num ber of the bridge po rt. Name Name that is assigned to the bridg e por t. Port I[...]
-
Page 214
7-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 CLI Command Use the show spantr ee port {802.1D | vlan { <vlan-id> | name <vlan- name> }} command to vi ew informat ion about Spannin g Tree bridge ports. Role The current role of the port. The options are: • Root • Designated • Alternate • Ba[...]
-
Page 215
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-17 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Configuring a Br idge Port Web A g e n t Procedure T o config ure a spann ing tree bridge port: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the L2 Switchin g folder . 2. Clic k Spanning T re e . The S pann ing Tree Infor mat ion W eb pa ge is dis p laye d in th e co nte n t pane[...]
-
Page 216
7-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 6. Configure the bridge port as a ppropriate. Ta b l e 7 - 5 provide s explanations of each field. 7. Click APPL Y to save your ch anges or CANCEL to res tore the previ ous settin gs. T able 7-5. Spanni ng T ree Port Config uration Field Defi nition Priority Prio[...]
-
Page 217
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-19 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Operational P ath Cost The path cost that Spanning T ree is using for the port: • If Administ rati ve Path Cost is set to a n onzero value, th i s field displays that nonzero value. • If Administrative Path Cost is set to 0 , the switch is ru nning Rapi d Spanning T r[...]
-
Page 218
7-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 CLI Commands Use the foll owing commands to c onfigure a Spanni ng T ree bridg e port: ■ T o set the pr iority of t he bridge port, (configure)# set po rt spantr ee priority <mod- swpo rt- rang e> [..., <mod-swport-r ange> ] <bport- priority> [...]
-
Page 219
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-21 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree Configuring S p anning T ree Settings for Swit ch Port s Web A g e n t Procedure T o configure Spanning T ree setti ngs for a switch port: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Modules & Ports folder . 2. Clic k Configuration . The Modu le Infor mation W eb pa ge i[...]
-
Page 220
7-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 Figure 7- 6. Switch Port Configurat ion W eb Page[...]
-
Page 221
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 7-23 Config uring Rapid Spa nning Tree 5. Enter th e app ro pr iate in for matio n in th e fo llow ing fi eld s: ■ Spanning T r ee Mode —Enable or dis a ble Spanning T ree on thi s port. If you click Disabl e , the port does not parti cipate in Spanni ng Tr e e . ■ Admin Poin t to Point Link —Speci fy [...]
-
Page 222
7-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 7 6. Click APPL Y to save your ch anges or CANCEL to res tore the previ ous settin gs. For in for m ati on ab ou t al l oth e r sw it ch p ort s e ttin gs, se e “ Configuring Swit ch Po rts S e ttin gs ” in Chapter 8 , “ Config uri ng Port s .” CLI Commands[...]
-
Page 223
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 8-1 8 Configuring Port s Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es are pr ovided in this c hapter and are common to both layer 2 and laye r 3 module confi guration: ■ T wo C ate g orie s of P ort S e ttin gs ■ Configur ing Physical Port Settings ■ Configur ing[...]
-
Page 224
8-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 8 Physical Port Features This sec tion describes the followin g feature s that are avai lable when configur ing the physi cal para m eters on the p orts: ■ Auto-negot iation ■ Remote Fault Detection ■ Flow Control Auto-negotiation Autonegotiati on is an exte[...]
-
Page 225
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-3 Config uring Ports It may seem t hat because the FLP and the normal li nk pulse use the same interval at the s ame frequency , older d evices may not be co m patible with auto-nego tiation. This i s, however , not the case . For example, a 10Base -T device th at does not have a uto-negotia tion capab iliti[...]
-
Page 226
8-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 8 * No te: If a Gigabit mo dul e th at does not suppor t t he a uto negotiation is connect ed to a device th at does, disa ble autone gotiation to ensu re pro per operat io n. Remote Fault Detection Remote fau l t detection is a proprieta ry feature that pr events[...]
-
Page 227
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-5 Config uring Ports Figure 8-1. R emote fa ult detec t ion Enable remot e fault detection on bot h ends of a switch-to-sw itch connectio n, in the followi ng two cases: ■ When two Gigab it ports that do not support aut o-negotiation are connecte d. ■ When a Gigabi t port t hat suppor ts auto- negotiat i[...]
-
Page 228
8-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 8 There ar e four flow control options on Gigabit Ethernet Ports. ■ Disable ■ Enable ■ Enable – Sen d Only ■ Enable – Respond Only The Disabl e option disable s flow cont rol (the defau lt). The Enable option enables IEEE802.3X (XOFF/XON) Flo w Control[...]
-
Page 229
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-7 Config uring Ports Switch Port Featur es The A vaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice swit ches support up t o 1000 VLANs and al so support multiple for warding database s. This means th at each VLAN is as sociated with its own Address Forwardi ng T able (AFT). The refo re, i den tica l MA C add r e sse s ca n [...]
-
Page 230
8-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 8 T able 8- 2. Re lat ion shi p Bet ween Sw it ch P ara m et ers VLAN Binding T runk Mod e Descripti on S tatic Clear In gress: Untagged frames are classified to the VLAN associated with the port on which the frame is received. T agged frames are clas sified to th[...]
-
Page 231
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-9 Config uring Ports Assigning VLANs to a Po rt and Associated Issues There are two ways to assign VLANs to ports on the A vaya Multiser vice Switch. Y ou configure the Port(s) to the VLA N desire d for the in dividual port(s) , or entire modul e. Assignin g the VLAN this way ena bles the port( s) to recei v[...]
-
Page 232
8-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 The second way is to assign t he VLAN to a port is by using the foll owing CLI command in Enable/Configur e mode: (configure)# set VLAN <vl an-id or name> <options > By select ing the VLAN na m e or VLAN ID, yo u can bind t he selected VLAN to addit i[...]
-
Page 233
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-11 Config uring Ports W i th th e set vlan CLI command , assign port 1, an d port 2 to VLAN4 and also assi gn port 4 to VLAN1 and VLAN2. T hen PC1 and PC2 could communicate wi th SER VER1 across VLANs withou t any noti ceable problems. Howev er , when PC1 transmits a packet to SER VER1, the follow ing occ ur[...]
-
Page 234
8-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o confi gure a por t on a 10-Gigabit m odule by using the W eb Agen t: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Modules & Ports folder . 2. Select Config uration . The Module I nformation W eb pag e is displayed in t he content pan[...]
-
Page 235
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-13 Config uring Ports Figure 8-3. Physical Port Co nfigurati on W eb Page for the 10-Gigabit Modu le 4. In the Enable column, sele ct the checkbox t o enable the por t. 5. Clic k APPL Y to save your sett ings, or CANCEL to restore pre vio us setting s. 6. In the Name column, sele ct the por t name. 7. The De[...]
-
Page 236
8-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 8. In the Name field, enter a port name, or you c an use the default n ame. 9. In the Category fiel d, select one of the following opt ions: — User Port if you wa nt t he switch to genera te only log messa ges for the port. This set ting prevents t he switch fr[...]
-
Page 237
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-15 Config uring Ports T ab le 8-3. Det ailed Physic al Port W eb Page Parameter Defi nition Name A n ame for this port. F o r example, you cou ld enter a drop connectio n name or the name of the station or other device that is connected to the port. Cat ego ry • The User Port option is intended for connect[...]
-
Page 238
8-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 CLI Command T o configur e ports on a 10 -Gigabit m odule, us e the following CLI command: (configure)# set po rt When you use t he CLI to configur e the 10-Gigabit module, enter the the module number in the format of <Slot N> - <Slo t N+1 > . F o r e[...]
-
Page 239
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-17 Config uring Ports Figure 8-5. Physical Port Co nfigurati on W eb Page for the Gigabit Ethernet Modul e 3. Click th e checkbo x in the Enable column to enabl e a port. A check mark displays . * Note: If the port is already enab led (c heck mark is visible), and y ou want to disable the port , click the bo[...]
-
Page 240
8-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Figure 8- 6. Detailed Physi cal Port Configurat ion W eb Page for Port o n Gigabit Et hernet Mo dule 6. En ter a p ort name in the Name field, i f desire d, or use the defa ult name suppli ed 7. Select one of the foll owing from the Categ ory field pull- down me [...]
-
Page 241
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-19 Config uring Ports 10. Selec t Enable fr o m the Full Duple x Flow Contr ol Advertisement field pu ll down menu 11 . Se lec t Enable fr o m the Pace Priori ty Mode fi eld pull down menu t o recogniz e and use 3Com’ s P ACE prior ity mechanism. 12. Selec t Enable fro m the Remote Faul t detect field pull[...]
-
Page 242
8-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Flow Contro l Mode This field determines if the po rt uses IEEE 802.3z pa use control. The pause m echanism allows the port to stop a send ing st ati o n fr om sendi ng m ore pa cke t s if th e buffe r s of the receiving p ort are f ull. Flow control helps preven[...]
-
Page 243
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-21 Config uring Ports CLI Command T o configure por ts on a gigabi t module using the CLI, ent er the followin g command from Conf igure mode: (configure)# set port <options> * Note: W hen a port on an 8 0-Series Giga bit Ether net module is disable d, the port link l ight bli nks continuousl y . In ve[...]
-
Page 244
8-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Figure 8- 7. Physical Port Configuration W eb Page for t he Fast Ethernet Module 4. By defaul t the chec kbox is chec ked in the Ena ble c olum n. T o change the enable remove the chec k in the check box. 5. If you change t he enable checkb ox Click APPL Y to sav[...]
-
Page 245
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-23 Config uring Ports Figure 8-8. D et ailed Phys i cal Port Configur ation W eb Page for Port on Fast Etherne t Module 7. Enter a port name in the Name field, if des ired or use the default name. 8. Sele ct one of the following fr om the Category field p ull-down menu: — User Port if this is an end- stati[...]
-
Page 246
8-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 10. Selec t a duplex mode (hal f-duplex or ful l-duplex) fro m the Duplex Mode field pul l-down menu i f you want to manual ly set the port ’ s duplex mode . Y ou do no t have to select a duplex mod e if you set the port t o autonegotiate . 11 . In the Flow Con[...]
-
Page 247
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-25 Config uring Ports 15. S elect one of the following from the Flood Rate Li mit Mode pull - down menu: Enable – If you want thi s port to limit the number of unknown unicas t and multic ast (flooded) packets it tri es to forwar d Disable – I f you do not want this port to l i mit the number of unk nown[...]
-
Page 248
8-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 T able 8-5. Fast Ethe rnet (10/100) Por t Parameters Parameter De finitio n Name Enter a user configurable name for this port (possibly a drop c onn ect ion n ame or the name of the sta tio n or ot her device connected t o the port). Category Select either User P[...]
-
Page 249
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-27 Config uring Ports CLI Command T o configure por ts on a Fast Ether net module using the CLI, e nter the following command from Configure m ode: (configure)# set port <options> Auto Negotiati on Duplex Advertisement Determines what information the port ad vertises wh en it starts auto-negotiating. I[...]
-
Page 250
8-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Using the All Po rt s Conf iguration Web Page Y ou can apply t he same parameter setting s on all of a module’ s ports using the All P orts Configurat ion W eb page. T o configur e all ports on a module: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Modules & Por[...]
-
Page 251
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-29 Config uring Ports CAUTION: Configurin g Switch Ports Y ou can configu re how each switch p ort performs it s switching func tions (for exa m ple, VLAN par a meters, hunt group a ssignments, trun k mode, and frame tag s cheme) through th e switch port par ameters. Y ou can configure swi tch port par amete[...]
-
Page 252
8-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Figure 8- 9. Switch Port Configurat ion W eb Page 4. En ter infor mat io n in the W eb pag e fi el ds a s appr op riat e. Se e Ta b l e 8 - 6 for an e xplanation of e ach fiel d.[...]
-
Page 253
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-31 Config uring Ports 5. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re stor e de fau lt setting s. * Note: Do not enab le Automatic VLAN Creation and VTP Snooping at the same time. Ta b l e 8 - 6 describes the Swi tch Port Configu r ation W eb page fields. T ab le 8-6. Swit ch Port Configurat ion W eb[...]
-
Page 254
8-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Allow Learning Select Disable to pr event th e port from learning n ew MAC addresses and forwarding th em to the Supervisor module to be added to the VLANs AFT . Enable is the default. For example, yo u can set this parameter to Disable, then add a static MA C ad[...]
-
Page 255
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-33 Config uring Ports Known Mode Enable or disable known mode. The default value is Disable. If know n mode is enab led , unicast frames that have an unknown des tination address are not flood ed out this por t. If know n mode is di sabled , un i cast frames that hav e an unknow n destinati on address ar e f[...]
-
Page 256
8-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Examp le See Ta b l e 8 - 7 as an example of t he recommended swi tch port sett ings for a Cisco Cat alyst 5000 TM . Admi n Ed ge Por t Specify w het he r th is po rt is an edge port or a nonedge port. An edge port is not connected to any other br i dge. Only e d[...]
-
Page 257
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-35 Config uring Ports CLI Command T o configure swi tch ports using the CLI, use t he foll owing CLI command: (configure)# set port <options> * Note: See the example s later in thi s section for r ecommendations o n how to set particular trunk port connection s. * Note: See “ VLAN Operation ” in Ch[...]
-
Page 258
8-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 T able 8-8. VLAN Binding Opt i ons Option Definiti on Stat ic Assigns VLAN membershi p manually , using the VLAN Switch Po rt s page descr i bed in “ Creating an d Implementing VLANs ” in Chap ter 6 , “ Using VLANs, Hunt Gr oups, and VTP Sno oping .” Bind[...]
-
Page 259
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-37 Config uring Ports Automatically Creating VLANs and Frame T ags Parameters VLANs are cr eated automati cally by the s w itch r eading the VLAN tag of al l ingress I EEE 802.1Q and Multi-Lay er tagged frames . The switch then creates a new VLAN for every new VLAN t ag identi fied. However , if t he para me[...]
-
Page 260
8-38 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o use t he W eb Agent to enabl e the MAC Address Lock f eature and traps for unkno w n source addre sses: 1. Manually add th e “permitted” MAC address es to the Address Forwardi ng T able (AFT). For in form atio n on ho w to m anu[...]
-
Page 261
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-39 Config uring Ports 4. Use th e following command t o enable known mode on a port or port range: set port known-mode <mod-swport- range> ena ble *Note: T o prevent th e flooding of fr ames that have unkn own desti nat ion addre sse s, e n ter a ll po rts on the sam e VL A N as the por t for which you[...]
-
Page 262
8-40 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Figure 8- 10. Switch Ports Conf iguration - All P orts W eb Page 4. Select the c heck box next to the field y ou want to c onfigure. 5. Select an opt ion for the spec ific field f rom that fields pull-down menu. 6. Select Restor e to keep t he previous se ttings [...]
-
Page 263
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-41 Config uring Ports Viewing Switch Port Settin gs Y ou can view swi tch port paramet ers through ei ther the W eb Agent and the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view swit ch port pa rameters usi ng the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Modules & Ports folder , and then click Configur[...]
-
Page 264
8-42 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 4. Select one of t he fo llowin g i tems a t the bott om of t he W eb page for more informa tion about the swi t ch ports: — Next/Pr evious Module – Dis plays the next or previous module’ s switch p ort parameters. — Modules – Returns you to the Modul e[...]
-
Page 265
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-43 Config uring Ports This sect ion contains pro cedures for t he foll owing tasks: ■ Creatin g a Port Redundan cy Pair ■ Deletin g a Port Redundancy Pa ir ■ Disabli ng or Enabling Port Redundancy Creating a Port Redu ndancy Pair Overview Y ou can use the W e b Agent or CLI to create a por t redundancy[...]
-
Page 266
8-44 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 3. Complete th e following: ■ Name —E nte r the pai r ’ s n am e . ■ Primary Port — Select the pai r ’ s primary por t from the pull-down menu. ■ Secondary Port — Select the pai r ’ s secondar y port fr om the pull- down menu. 4. Click Apply . C[...]
-
Page 267
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-45 Config uring Ports Disabling or En abling Port Redu ndancy Web A g e n t Procedure Y ou can globa ll y enable or d is abl e port redunda ncy i n t he Port Redunda ncy Configurat ion W eb page. Dis abling redundanc y does not del ete the pa irs. T o enable or disabl e a port redundan cy 1. In t he navigati[...]
-
Page 268
8-46 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 GBIC I dentific ation The G B IC Id ent ific a tion fea tu re id enti fies the type o f GBI Cs t hat ar e instal led in 80-seri es gigabi t modules with GBIC int erfaces. The fe ature identi fies the foll owing ty pes of conne ctors: ■ GB IC SX (s ho rt w av e [...]
-
Page 269
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-47 Config uring Ports Network Error Detect ion and Recovery Overview Functionality The Network Er ror Detection and Rec overy (NEDR) featur e monitors Ethernet C RC errors on Ethe rnet data port s and compares t he rate o f errors that occu rs to the thres hold values that you set. This feature helps you fin[...]
-
Page 270
8-48 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Hardware Support Y ou can enable NEDR onl y for ports on gi gabit and 10-gig abit Ethernet modules an d only by using CLI co m mands. Y ou cannot enabl e the feature on any oth er types of po rts, for example, Ethernet 10/100, A TM Uplink, or supervi sor, and can[...]
-
Page 271
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-49 Config uring Ports See Ta b l e 8 - 1 1 for expla nations of the ke ywords, ar guments, and options i n this command. The CLI disp lays a confirmat i on message if you successfully e nable NEDR for a por t or range of por ts. If no me ssage displays, t he port inform ation was i nvalid. * Note: Occasional[...]
-
Page 272
8-50 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 * Note: I f you set the ri sing threshold value and the falling threshold value c l ose together , events may be logg ed more often if the Notify op ti on is sel ec ted . * Note: No c onfiguration event is generated in t he event log when yo u enable or disable N[...]
-
Page 273
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-51 Config uring Ports Internal Error Detection and Recovery Overview The Inter nal Error Detect ion and Recovery (I EDR) feature shut s down a port if it s rate of i nte rna l errors exce eds the thr es hol d s etting. Curr ent ly you can enable t his featur e only by usin g the CLI and only fo r ports on 50[...]
-
Page 274
8-52 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Ena bling IEDR * Note: T o enable IEDR for por ts in a hunt gro up, you must us e a dif ferent com mand that enable s the featu re globally fo r all ports in all h unt g rou ps on t he s witch . Fo r inf orma tio n on th is comm an d, s ee “ Enabling IEDR for H[...]
-
Page 275
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-53 Config uring Ports T o globally d isable IEDR for al l ports in hunt groups, ent er: set huntgr oup internal- erro r- shutdown disa ble Settin g the IEDR Th reshol d for Internal Errors Y ou can set the threshol d at which the swi t ch will shutdown a port. By default t his threshold is set to 10 int erna[...]
-
Page 276
8-54 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 Error Messages * Note: If IEDR d ete ct s err ors on a po rt i n the hunt gro up, it tes ts ea ch port wit hin that hun t group. Wh en it finds the first bad po rt, it removes i t from the hunt gr oup and disables the port. The I EDR feat ure m ay d is pla y th e[...]
-
Page 277
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 8-55 Config uring Ports Internal-error-config enabled on por t 7/1 Internal-error-config enabled on por t 7/2 Internal-error-config enabled on por t 7/3 Internal-error-config enabled on por t 7/4 Feature enabled for port(s) specifie d If CRC Error Threshold is exceeded t hen port will automatically be shut dow[...]
-
Page 278
8-56 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 8 ■ Upon Success: Threshold value set to 10 ■ Upon Failur e (The only fai lure th at can occur i s that t he number entered wa s not in t he range 5 – 500): Threshold value must be between 5 and 500[...]
-
Page 279
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 9-1 9 Managing the Address Forwarding T able Ove rview The Address Forwardi ng T able (AFT) is a mapping ta ble of MAC a ddresses with the ir ass oci ated p ort l oca tio ns .Th e AFT is u sed by the A va ya Mu lti ser vic e swit ch to corr ectl y fo rward (br idge) fram es d e[...]
-
Page 280
9-2 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 9 For mor e inform ation abo ut the CLI commands that are ment ioned in t his chapter , see Command Refer ence Guide for the A vaya P580 and P882 Multiser vice Swit ches, Softwar e V ersion 6.1 Chapter content s The followin g information and procedures ar e in th[...]
-
Page 281
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-3 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table Hash T able and Buc ke t me mo ry usage guidelines The A vaya Mul t iservice swit ch provid es 60K of memory tha t is used to store hash ta bl es and AFT bucket s. In general, no more then 20K shoul d be used for Ha sh T ables, leaving 4 0K available for AFT ent ries[...]
-
Page 282
9-4 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 9 VLAN ID number out side the recommended range If you us e an ID number outsi de the range of r ecommended numbers , you may f ind cert ain VLAN ID numbers cause “collisions” and are unava i lable when you t ry to create a new VLAN. The r eas on for this has [...]
-
Page 283
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-5 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table If the number of VLANs s uppo rted in the switch is 500, th en t he VLAN ID numbers used in the switch sho uld be chos en from the range o f 1 to 500 rather t hen 1 to 100 0. Ta b l e 9 - 2 is an exampl e of the siz e of t he ha sh t abl e cr eated per the number of [...]
-
Page 284
9-6 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 9 Examples of Configuring VLANs and Hash T able Size Examp le 1 All VLANs have the same Hash T able Size Conf igure the A vaya Mu ltis ervic e sw i tch for 45 VLA N s. Th is req uires the default Hash T able size be r educed accor ding to the hash t able guidelin [...]
-
Page 285
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-7 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table AFT Default Set tings Figure 9-1. Create VLANs Name —Name for the new VLAN ID —VLAN ID number , valid number between 1- 4094 (1 is reserved f or the Default VLAN) Instance I D —Instance tabl e representation o f a VLAN. The Instance ID does not di rectly correl[...]
-
Page 286
9-8 User Guid e for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switc hes, v6 .1 Chapt er 9 Figure 9- 2. Address Forwarding T able Con figuration Auto-Increment Auto-I ncrement is the Enable/Di sab le setting for the Auto- Sizing featur e. If Auto -In cr em en t is ena bl ed, th e sw i tch wil l a uto mati call y in cr eas e the h ash table s i ze prov[...]
-
Page 287
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-9 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table It is hig hly recommended t he default of 4 0% not be cha nged. The affects of varying the Th reshold (Uti l%) are as follows: ■ Incr easing Threshol d: Gives better memory utili z ation at the expense o f more frequent flus hing, flo oding, and r e learning. ■ D[...]
-
Page 288
9-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 Enter a n ew value in the Supe r Age Time fi eld. The va lid entrie s are 1-30 days . The Supe r Age T i me r m ark s all i nva li d ta ble e ntr ie s, t he n ch ecks to see i f th ey rema in i nvali d fo r th e sp ecif ied s upe r ag e in terv al. T his clea rs [...]
-
Page 289
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-11 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table Figure 9-3. A ddress T able Inst ance W eb page See Ta b l e 9 - 3 for a defini tion of the Ad dress T able Instance W eb page para mete rs. T able 9-3. Add res s T abl e Instan ce Par amet ers Paramete r Definition VLAN Association Name of the VLAN this Has h table[...]
-
Page 290
9-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 Entry T ype Displays the ent ry ty pe for this VLAN. Options i nclude: • Learne d - Entry is dy namically learned. • Managem ent - Entry is conf i gured by the user statically . • Self - Entries for internal address es contained with in the switch. • Mult[...]
-
Page 291
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-13 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table 3. Clic k: ■ APPL Y to save your changes ■ CANCEL to restore previous set ti ngs ■ Delete Al l Learned Entr ies if yo u wa nt to rele arn th e en tir e tab le ■ Delete I nvalid Learne d Entries if you wan t to dele te all entrie s that ar e currently age d o[...]
-
Page 292
9-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o f ilte r th e A F T us in g th e W eb A gent : 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the L2 Switching > Addr ess Forwarding T able folde rs, an d th en cl ick Address Sear ch . The Addres s Entry Search W eb page is di splayed in t[...]
-
Page 293
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-15 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table 3. T o se arch usin g a VLAN: — Select the VLAN check box in t he Search By: colum n — Select a VLAN name from the VLAN fiel d pull-d own menu in the Search V alue: column. 4. T o search using a P ort: — Select the Port chec k box in the Sear ch By: column —[...]
-
Page 294
9-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 Figure 9- 5. Address Forwarding T able W eb Page * Note: Some types of ent ri es in the Addre ss Forwa rdi ng T able can be modifie d. The port, prior ity , and persisten ce can be changed fo r learne d and mana gement entr ies. 7. T o change an en try in th e Ad[...]
-
Page 295
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-17 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table 9. After making the changes , click the APPL Y button to save the c urrent setting s, or CANCEL to restore previo us settings . or MO RE to view more st atistics. 10. S ee Ta b l e 9 - 4 to revi ew your search cr iteria option s: T a ble 9-4. Addr ess Forwarding T a[...]
-
Page 296
9-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 Persistence The persistence of the entry in the table can be set on all learned entries: • Permanent - The address is n ot aged out of th e table. • Invalid - This entry is cleared from the table ea ch time the switch resets . • Ageout - Address is cleared [...]
-
Page 297
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-19 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table CLI Command T o se ar ch t he s w itch A FT u sing the C LI, e nte r t he fo llo w ing co mm and in Configur e mod e: (configure)# show af t entry Adding S t atic Entries to th e AFT Y ou can add stat ic entr ies to the AFT man ually usi ng the W eb Agent o r the CL[...]
-
Page 298
9-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 3. In the VLAN field, sele ct a VLAN for this en try . 4. In the Port Binding fiel d, select Forwar d or Fi lter : ■ Forward —Frames that have this source or destination MAC address are for war ded. If you select Forward , you mu st en t er th e port that you[...]
-
Page 299
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 9-21 Managi ng the Address F orwarding Table 8. In the DA-Priority field, selec t th e pr ior ity th at y ou w ant asso ciate d w ith frames th at have this des tination MAC addres s: ■ None ■ Aft —Use s t he p ri ori ty tha t is a ss igned to t he MAC addre ss in th e AFT . If y ou select this option, y[...]
-
Page 300
9-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 9 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o use t he W eb Agent to change the status of o ption 82: 1. Open the IP Globa l Configuration W eb page. For inf ormation on how to ope n this W eb page, see “ Enabl ing IP Routing Gl obal Paramete rs ” in Chap ter 12 , “ Confi[...]
-
Page 301
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 10-1 10 Configur ing Redundancy Options Ove rview The A vaya Multi service Switch c an be configured w ith redund ancy to prov ide faul t tole ran c e. For more informa tion about the CLI comman ds that are menti oned in this chapter , see Comman d Refer ence Guide for the A va[...]
-
Page 302
10-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 10 VRRP The A vaya Mult iservic e Switch supports V irtual Router Redundancy Protocol (VRRP), an IETF protoc ol designed to su pport redundant L A N routers , a s well as lo ad bal ancing of tr af fic . VRRP i s tra nspare nt to hos t end stati ons. All conf igura[...]
-
Page 303
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-3 Configu ring Redund ancy Options Configuring Re dundant Hardware The A vaya Mul tiservice swit ches p rovide a r edundant backplan e to ensure that should a Supervisor module, Swit ch Controller , or fabric element fa il, it will cont inue to fo rward data proper ly . The redundant components a re availab[...]
-
Page 304
10-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 10 Figure 10- 2. Layout of the Redun dant Backplane for P88 2 Chassis The A vaya Multiser vice switc hes are equipped with diagnost ics to: ■ Mo nito r t he s tatu s of the Pr im ary sw itc h co n trol ler . ■ Mo nito r t he s tatu s of a A cti ve e le me n t.[...]
-
Page 305
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-5 Configu ring Redund ancy Options Inst alling and Enabling Re dundant Hardware The standar d switch conf igurati on does not inc lude a red undant contro ller or el em ent. T he co rrec t pr ocess is to : ■ Instal l the red unda nt hardware. See “ Installing Redundant Hardware .” ■ Enable the redun[...]
-
Page 306
10-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 10 Enabling R edunda nt Hardw a re We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o enabl e redundant hardware using t he W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Syste m > C onf igur ation folde rs, and then c lick Switch Fabric . The Switc h Fabric Sta tus W eb page[...]
-
Page 307
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-7 Configu ring Redund ancy Options Figure 10-4. Switch Fabric S tatus W eb Page CLI Command T o enable the re dundant hardware b y using the CLI, enter the foll owing command from E nab le/C onf igure mode: (configure)# s et fabric co nfigure-r edundant-hardwar e enable Replacin g the Primar y Controll er I[...]
-
Page 308
10-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 10 W ARNIN G: Figure 10- 5. Switch Fabr ic S tatus W eb Page If a re dundant controll er is install ed in the switc h and enabled, t he switch resets and th e redundant control ler aut omaticall y takes o ver the op eration of the fa iled Prim ary c ont roll er . [...]
-
Page 309
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-9 Configu ring Redund ancy Options W ARNIN G: Replacing a n Element If an ele m ent fa ils, you are noti fied by: ■ An ev ent lo g m e ssag e ■ An error m essage that displays i n the S witch El em ents fie ld T o repl ace a f ai le d el em en t: 1. Disab le redundant hardware. 2. Cop y the runni ng con[...]
-
Page 310
10-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 10 CLI Command T o enabl e an element using the CLI, enter th e following co mmand from Configur e mode: > set fabr ic configur e-redundant- hardware en able Configuring Sup e rvisor Module Red undant Ethernet Console IP Addr esses We b A g e n t Proc edu re If[...]
-
Page 311
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-11 Configu ring Redund ancy Options 2. Enter th e inte rnal I P ad dres ses of th e slot 1 and slot 2 CPUs in the Redundant CPU Consol e IP Address f ield. The addresses cannot be the same as the console IP o r each other . The Gateway must be on the sam e subn et a s the IP ad dress es. This sets the IP ad[...]
-
Page 312
10-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 10 Synchronizing the Active and St andby CPUs Overview After i nstalling the active an d standby supervi sor modules, you must synchroni ze them. Y ou can use the W eb Agent or CLI to pe rform the synchroni zation. * Note: I f the Active Super visor module and t h[...]
-
Page 313
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-13 Configu ring Redund ancy Options Supervisor Modu le Redundancy S t atis tics The active supervisor per iodically sends a health re port messag e to the standby (r edundant) su pervisor . If th e standby supervi sor is enabled, it responds wi th a health repo rt reply . Health re port statisti cs are di s[...]
-
Page 314
10-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 10 CAUTION: * Note: If the stan dby sup ervisor becomes ac ti ve, it ass umes the IP and MAC addresse s of the previou sly active supe rvisor . * Note: When a standby supervi sor is instal led in th e switch there i s a 45-seco nd wait period bef ore the standby s[...]
-
Page 315
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-15 Configu ring Redund ancy Options Synchroniza tion Procedure Web A g e n t Procedure * Note: Y ou must s ynchronize the a ctive and standb y supervisor modules for the st andby (r edun dant) supe rvisor to use the s ame configur ation as the act ive supervisor . Save t he running conf igu rati on t o th e[...]
-
Page 316
10-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 10 Figure 10- 7. CPU Redundancy S tatus W eb Page 3. Monitor the CPU redundanc y statistics to ensure tha t the health messages between the su pervisor modules a re being sent an d received. Click REFRESH to ensu re that the counters increment. See T able 10- 2 fo[...]
-
Page 317
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 10-17 Configu ring Redund ancy Options 4. Clic k SYNCH RONIZE to sta r t the synchroni zation process . If both s upervisors are running v6.0 or later a pplication sof tware, the switch pe rforms the fo llowing che cks after yo u synchroni ze the active and stand by supervisor s: ■ V ersion of application so[...]
-
Page 318
10-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 10[...]
-
Page 319
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 11-1 11 Configuring DNS Client Ove rview This chapt er provides an ov erview of the Domain Naming System (DNS) Client su pport and procedur es for configur ing DNS client supp ort on the A vaya Multiserv ice switc h: ■ DNS Client S upport ■ DNS Client o n the A vaya Multi s[...]
-
Page 320
11-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 11 Recurs ive vs. Iter ati ve The goal of DNS is to resol ve a fully qual ified domain name ( FQDN) to an IP addre ss. This work can ei ther be done by th e DNS server or the DNS client . These approaches are referred t o as Recur sive or Iterat ive, respect ively[...]
-
Page 321
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 11-3 Configuring DNS Client Sample Recursive DN S Query T ypically , a net work will have a l ocal DNS server whic h provides tra n slat ion s fo r d evi ces in the loca l n etw or k. That ser ver w ill also “ kno w” the IP addr ess of the Root s ervers. When a cl ient at tempts to communicat e with a devi[...]
-
Page 322
11-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 11 DNS Client on the A vaya Multiservi ce Switch The A vaya Multis ervice switch ha s DNS client capabi lities that work in conj unc ti on wi th th e Com man d Lin e In te rfa ce (CL I). T his fe atu re is u sefu l for tes ting connectivi ty (ping and tr aceroute)[...]
-
Page 323
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 11-5 Configuring DNS Client Order of O perations for DNS on the Switch Y ou can configure up to si x DNS servers and up to six DNS suf fi xes. When you use a na m e inste ad of an IP addres s in a command, the A vaya Multise rvice switch wil l first c heck to see if t he name is a ful ly qualified domain name [...]
-
Page 324
11-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 11 Configuring the DNS Client Y ou can confi gure DNS client fr om the W eb Agent or the CLI . We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o confi gure a DNS cl ient by using the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Syste m > C onf igur ation folde rs, and then[...]
-
Page 325
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 11-7 Configuring DNS Client Figure 1 1-1. DNS Configur ation W eb Page[...]
-
Page 326
11-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 11 2. Select Enable from th e DNS Lookup field pull- down menu to enabl e DNS on the s w itch. *Note: W hen DNS is ena bled and con figured, you ca n enter DNS names in pla ce of IP addre sses for the following CLI commands. Aga i n, DNS is for use wit h the CLI o[...]
-
Page 327
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 11-9 Configuring DNS Client Avaya(configure)# ip name-s erver 20.20.20.20 Added name server ’20.20.20.20’ to the name serv er list. Avaya(configure)# ip name-server 30.30.30.3 0 Added name server ’30.30.30.30’ to the name serv er list. Avaya(configure)# ip domain- l ist avaya.c om Added domain name ’[...]
-
Page 328
11-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 11[...]
-
Page 329
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 12-1 12 Configuring IP Routing Ove rview The A vaya Multi service Switch s upports the ful l suite of IP protocols f or unicast a nd multicast pac ket routi ng and control. It is c ompatible w ith the install ed base of IP routers and does not requir e changes to softwar e in h[...]
-
Page 330
12-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 12 ■ Configuri ng VRRP ■ Configuri ng IRDP ■ Configuri ng LDAP ■ Configuri ng a Static Route for the PPP Con sole ■ Configuri ng the IP Interf ace for the P PP Console For mor e inform ation abo ut the CLI commands that are ment ioned in t his chapter , [...]
-
Page 331
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-3 Config uring IP Routing Requirement s for IP Routing Hardware Requirement s T o configure your switch as an IP router , you must configu re your switch with the fo llo w ing h ardw are: ■ Layer 3 su pervisor module * No te: Licensed layer 3 80-ser ies media modules are recommended for best routi ng perf[...]
-
Page 332
12-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Routing Configu ration Quickst art This sec t ion provides an overview of the ho w to conf igure th e A vaya Multiser vice switch as a IP router . T o confi gure the s witch as a IP rout er: 1. Ensure that p hysical port par ameters and cabl ing are correct ly [...]
-
Page 333
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-5 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-2. IP Interface s W eb Page 2. T o modi fy an IP i nt erfa ce, fi rst s ele ct th e spec ific inte rfac e, th en m o dif y the p ara mete rs, and the n cl ick APPL Y or CANCEL to r estor e pre vious setting s. * Note: If you modify t he ARP T imeout value, t he new value [...]
-
Page 334
12-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Creating and Assigning IP Inter faces to the VLAN We b A g e n t Proc edu re After yo u have set up a VLAN, y ou must crea te the IP inter face that your VLAN and your s ubnet uses to communicate wi th each ot her . While creati ng the IP interf ace, you must a[...]
-
Page 335
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-7 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-3. Add IP Interface W eb page[...]
-
Page 336
12-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 12 T able 12-1. Add IP Interface W eb Page Fie lds Parameter Allows yo u to... Name Enter a unique, alphanumeric nam e for the interface (maximum 30 characters ) VLAN A p u ll down menu that associates a VLAN wit h this IP Interface. Note: The way t hat you config[...]
-
Page 337
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-9 Config uring IP Routing MAC Format Select the MAC addr es s format for the i nterface. Options i nclude: • Ethernet V2 • Simple Network Access Protocol (SNAP) ARP T imeout Enter t he timeout per i od for Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) in seconds.Th e ARP T imeout value is the period of time the swi[...]
-
Page 338
12-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Commands T o create an IP interf ace, you must use two CLI co mmands: 1. Create an Int erface Name fi rst. (configure)# interfa ce < interface _name> typ e <etherne t | nbma> Example: (configure)# interface myif type ethernet 2. As sig n an IP a[...]
-
Page 339
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-11 Config uring IP Routing Web A g e n t Procedure T o enable IP routin g using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > Configurat ion folders , and then cli c k Global . The IP Global Con figuration W eb page is displ ayed in the content pane. See Figure 12 -4 . Figure[...]
-
Page 340
12-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 2. See T able 12-2 to con figure the IP Glo bal Configurati on W eb page. 3. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. T able 12-2. IP Gl obal Configuration Parameters Parameter Allows y ou to... IP Unicast Forwardi ng Disable[...]
-
Page 341
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-13 Config uring IP Routing Maximum Number of Rou tes Enter the maxi mu m n umber of routes that yo u wa n t added to the routing table. The default number o f routes is 16 384 . Note: These rou tes refer only to IP Unicast entries. Maximum Num ber of AR P Cache Entries Enter the maximum number of ARP cache [...]
-
Page 342
12-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 IP Mult inetti ng Y ou can set up a configuratio n of multiple subnets, a nd IP interf aces on a single VLAN. This is also referr ed to as IP M ult inett ing . A network is said to be mu ltinett ed when multiple l ogical groups of computers are br ought togethe[...]
-
Page 343
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-15 Config uring IP Routing Creating a Multinet Interface T o crea te a m u ltin et inte rfa ce: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > Configurat ion folders , and then cli c k In ter fac es. The IP Int erfaces W eb page is displaye d in the content pane. See Fi gure 12-2 . 2. Sele ct[...]
-
Page 344
12-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 If the f orwarding cache contains a hi gh number of short- lived protocol entrie s, you can set t he switch to use the slow pa th to route p ackets of a specifi c short-live d protocol. By usin g the slow path to rou te short - lived protocol traffi c, you co n[...]
-
Page 345
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-17 Config uring IP Routing Examples T o send a ll SNMP packets t o supervis or module for slow path rou ting, ente r the fo llowing com mand: ip sh ort- live d udp 161 T o send all BOOTP a nd DHCP packets to the supervisor for slow path routing, e nter the fol lowing command: ip sh ort- live d udp 67 ip sh [...]
-
Page 346
12-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Examp les T o disable the sho rt-lived IP prot ocol filter f or DNS, enter the following command: no ip short - lived udp 53 T o d isa bl e th e sh or t-li ved IP pr o toc ol f ilt er fo r N T P , en ter th e fo l low ing command: no ip short -lived udp 123 Dis[...]
-
Page 347
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-19 Config uring IP Routing Creating IP St atic R outes Y ou can create IP static routes using either t he W eb Agent or t he CLI. *Import ant: Do not create a st atic route t o a local int erface. This configurat i on is not supported. Web A g e n t Procedure T o create I P static routes using the W eb Agen[...]
-
Page 348
12-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Commands T o create and show I P static route s use the followi ng CLI commands: ■ T o crea te a n I P st atic ro ute , (configure)# ip route <ip-addr> <mask> <next hop IP addre ss> <cost> <pre fere nce> ■ T o view all I P [...]
-
Page 349
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-21 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-7. Null Interface Exa m ple In the pre ceding figure, Ro uter 1 has a de fault r oute that point s to the Border Route r for addresse s that are not kn own within the e nterpri se. If a null interface is not con figured: 1. Router 3 forwar ds packets that hav e a destin [...]
-
Page 350
12-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Procedure We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o creat e a stat ic route to a null interfa ce: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > Configur ation folde rs. 2. Click St a t i c R o u t e s . Th e IP Stat ic Rou tes W eb p age is d is pla yed in [...]
-
Page 351
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-23 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-8. IP S tatic ARP Entri es W eb Page 2. Sele ct C REA TE . The Add I P Static ARP Entry W eb page is displaye d. See Fig ure 12-9 . Figure 12-9. Add IP S tatic A RP Entry W eb Pag e 3. See Ta b l e 1 2 - 6 to configure the Add IP Sta tic ARP Entry W eb page para mete rs:[...]
-
Page 352
12-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Creating a BOOTP/DHCP Server Entry The BOOTP/DHCP Serve r Entry allows yo u to configure a Ro uter as a BOOTP/DHCP Relay Agen t between a BOOTP/DHCP serv er and the request ing client. Y ou can creat e a BOOTP/DHCP Server entry using e ither th e W eb Agent or [...]
-
Page 353
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-25 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o create a BOOTP/DHCP entry using the CLI, enter the foll owing command in Co nfigure mod e: (configure)# ip bo ot-dhcp server <ip- address> Configuring Ro ute Redistribution Overview Route redi stribution makes it possible f or differ ent IP routing p rotocols[...]
-
Page 354
12-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 This sec t ion contains t he followi ng procedu res: ■ Creating a n IP Redistribut e List Ent ry ■ V iewing IP Redi stribut e List Entries ■ Modifying an IP Redistribut e List Entry ■ Deleting a n IP Redistribut e Entry Creating an IP Red istribute List[...]
-
Page 355
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-27 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-13 . Add IP Redistribut e List Ent ry 5. In the Access List field , selec t an access li st to filter the routes that are redistr ibuted. If you s e lect NA , all routes ar e redistribut ed. * No te: Y ou can use dif fere nt access lists for dif fer ent IP r edistri bute[...]
-
Page 356
12-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 V iewing IP Redistribute L ist Entries We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o view I P redistr ibute list en tries: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > Configur ation folde rs. 2. Click IP Re dis t r ibu te Li st . The IP Redi stribute List Ent[...]
-
Page 357
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-29 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-14 . IP Redistrib ute List Ent r ies W eb Page 2. Sele ct the route redistr i bution entry t hat you want to modi fy . 3. Modify the entry as nec essary . 4. Clic k APPL Y . CLI Command T o modify an IP redist ri but e li st entr y , use the sam e r edistribute command t[...]
-
Page 358
12-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 2. Select the r oute redistri bution en try that you wa nt to del ete. 3. Click Delete . CLI Commands T o del ete an IP r edist ribu te l ist e nt ry , use the fo llo wing CLI c omm ands : ■ T o delete an entry that redi stribut es routes to RIP , (configure [...]
-
Page 359
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-31 Config uring IP Routing This sect ion contains the following pr ocedures: ■ Conf igu rin g IG MP ■ Globally Enabling IGMP ■ Modifyi ng IGMP Inter faces ■ Configur ing and Mod i fying DVMRP ■ Configur ing the DVMRP Gl obal Confi guration ■ Modifying a DVMRP Interface Configurin g IGMP IGMP ena[...]
-
Page 360
12-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 15. IGMP Global Configura tion W eb Page 4. Select Enable from th e IGMP field pull-down m enu to e nable IGMP . 5. Select Enable from th e MTRACE field pull -down menu to enab le MTRACE processi ng. 6. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL t[...]
-
Page 361
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-33 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-16 . IGMP Interfaces W eb page 2. See Ta b l e 1 2 - 8 to modify an IGMP inter face. 3. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re pr evi ous setting s. T ab le 12-8. IGMP I nterface Paramet ers Parameter Allows y ou to... Select Select the interface to [...]
-
Page 362
12-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o mo dif y an IG MP inte rf ace usi ng the CLI, ente r the foll o win g comm an d from in ter face m ode: (config-if: <interface> )# ip igm p <options> Always be Group Membership Querier V ersion 1.0 - Select Enab le to make this inter[...]
-
Page 363
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-35 Config uring IP Routing Configurin g and Modif ying DVMRP Distance V ector Mult icast Routing Protoco l (DVMRP) uses IP pac kets with protocol type 2 (IGMP) to exch ange routi ng datagrams. DVMRP enabl es multic ast r out er s t o exchange dis ta nce vector updat es th at contain multica st flow list s a[...]
-
Page 364
12-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 17. DVMRP Global Conf iguration W eb Page 4. Select Enable from th e DVMRP V ersion 3/0xFF field. 5. See T able 12-9 to con figure the DVMRP Global Configurat ion W eb page p ara m ete rs. 6. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore p[...]
-
Page 365
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-37 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o configure DVMRP globa lly using the CLI : (configure)# r outer dvmrp Neighbor R outer T imeout Interval Enter the time-out interval (in s econds) that a neighbor stays up without confirm a tio n. This is an important method used to tim e- out ol d routes . The vali[...]
-
Page 366
12-38 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Modifying a DVMRP Interface Y ou can modi fy a DVM RP i nte rf ace using ei th er th e W eb Agent o r t he CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o modify a DMVRP interfa ce using the W eb Agen t: 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Routing > DVMRP folders, a[...]
-
Page 367
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-39 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o con figu re t h e DVM RP Inte rf ace usi ng the C LI: (configure-if: <interface> )# i p dvmrp <options> Interface T ype Select an Interface ty p e. Y ou can configure the interface type as: • Br oadcast - All t raffi c is forwarded through t he router[...]
-
Page 368
12-40 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Monitor ing Switch Performance Using IP S tatistics This sect ion pr ovides detai led inf orma tion on the ana lysis and use o f IP and IP mult icast s tatistics. IP routi ng statistic options i nclude: ■ Displayin g Global IP Routi ng Stat istics ■ Searchi[...]
-
Page 369
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-41 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-19 . IP Routing Global S tat istics W eb Page 2. C lick — Clear to set al l s tati stic s to ze ro. — Refr esh to updat e all st atistics. 3. See Ta b l e 1 2 - 1 1 t o review the defi nition of each s t atistic: T able 12-1 1. IP Routing Glob al S tatistic s S tat i[...]
-
Page 370
12-42 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 IP In Address Errors Number of input datagrams discarded because the IP address in their IP header’ s destination field was not a valid a ddress to be received at this entity . This count includes invalid address es (for example, 0 .0.0.0) and addresses of un[...]
-
Page 371
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-43 Config uring IP Routing IP Out Discar ds Number of outp ut IP da tagrams fo r which no problem was encoun t ered to prev ent their transmissi on to their destin ation, but were discarded (for ex ample, for lack of buf fer space). Note that this counter includes da tagrams counted in ipForwD a tagram s if[...]
-
Page 372
12-44 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 ICMP In Errors Number of ICMP messages that the entity received but deter mined as having IC M P-specific errors ( bad ICMP checksums, bad length). ICMP In Destination Unreachables Number of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages received. ICMP In T ime Exceeds [...]
-
Page 373
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-45 Config uring IP Routing ICMP Out Source Quenchs Number of ICMP Source Quench m es sages sent. ICMP Out Redi rects Number of IC MP Redirect messages sent. For a host, this object will always be zero, s ince hosts do not se nd redir ects. ICMP Out E cho Requests Number of ICMP Ec ho (request) messages se n[...]
-
Page 374
12-46 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o display the global IP routing stati st ics using t he CLI, ent er the foll owi ng command f rom the enab le mode or configur ation mode promp t: > show ip tr affic Searching the IP Ro uting T a ble T o use th e IP routi ng table: 1. In the na[...]
-
Page 375
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-47 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-20 . IP Route T able Search W eb Page 2. Sele ct the searc h criter ia you want to use to find more s pecific inform ation on a vailable route s. For example, if y ou want to find al l static routes that ar e present l y configured on your switch, sear ch by sour ce and [...]
-
Page 376
12-48 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 21. IP Route T able W eb Page * Note: T o delete a local entry from your I P routing table , you must delete the local I P inte rface as sociated with th at entry . Displaying the IP Routing T able St atisti cs T o display the IP Routing T able S tat[...]
-
Page 377
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-49 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o display th e IP rou ting t able s tati stics , enter the f ollowi ng comman d from the prompt: > show ip r oute summary Searching the I P ARP Cache T o search the IP ARP Cache en tries: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > Display fo ld [...]
-
Page 378
12-50 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 23. ARP Cache Entry Sea rch W eb Page 2. Se lec t the se arc h cr it eria you want to u se to fi nd m ore s pec ific informa t ion on your switch’ s curr ent ARP cache. For exa m ple, if you want to f in d all of the IP ARP c ac he e ntries asso ci[...]
-
Page 379
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-51 Config uring IP Routing IP Mult icast S t atisti cs Y ou can view I P Multicast sta t istics through by using either the W eb Agent or th e CLI . IP m ult ic ast stat isti cs inc lude: ■ Displayi ng IGMP Global S tatistics ■ Disp layin g IGM P In terf ace Stati stic s ■ Displayi ng the IGMP Gro up [...]
-
Page 380
12-52 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 24. IGMP Global S tat istics W eb Page 2. T o modify your glob al statistics, p erform one of the following: — Click CLEAR to r eset all stat istics to zero — Click REFRESH to view th e la test stat is tics . 3. See T able 12-15 for a n explanati[...]
-
Page 381
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-53 Config uring IP Routing Web A g e n t Procedure T o disp l ay th e IGM P In terf ace Stat istic s us in g th e W eb A ge nt : 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IGMP folde rs, and th en click Inter face S tatistics . The IGMP In terface S tatis tics W eb page is displ ayed in the con t[...]
-
Page 382
12-54 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 This Rout er is Gro up Membership Querier Router that was configured or elected to be the designated gr oup mem bership querier . The switch queries hosts on each interf ace on ly when it is acting as the designated querier on that interface. Robustness V ariab[...]
-
Page 383
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-55 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o di sp lay the IG MP Inte rf ace Statistic s us ing th e C L I, ent er th e foll ow in g command from con figuration mode: (configure)# show ip ig m p s tat is tics Displaying the IGMP Gro up Membership T able The multica st group table p rovides informat ion on int[...]
-
Page 384
12-56 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o display the multicast gr oup table using t he CLI, enter the following command f rom configu r ation mode: (configure)# show i p ig m p g roup s Displaying the IGMP Local Multicas t Forward ing Cache T o displ ay the m ulticast forwarding c ache[...]
-
Page 385
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-57 Config uring IP Routing 2. T o modify the Local Mul t icast Forwarding Cache, select an entry a nd: — Click Delete En try to delete one or more entri es. — Click Fl ush T able to clear the en tire tab le . — Click REFRESH to recei ve th e most up-to -da te infor mation on the en trie s in the t ab [...]
-
Page 386
12-58 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 28. DVMRP Global S tatist ics W eb Page 2. C lick: — CLEAR to re set a ll st atis tic s to zer o — REFRESH to view the latest statistics. 3. See T able 12-19 f or an expl anation of the DVMRP Global S tati stics W eb page p ara m ete rs: T able 1[...]
-
Page 387
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-59 Config uring IP Routing Displaying DVMRP Interface St atistics DVMRP interf ace statisti cs list acti ve DVMRP interface s and provide specifi c information on each interfa ce. Web A g e n t Procedure T o disp lay D VM RP i n terf ace stat isti cs u si ng t he W e b Ag e nt: 1. In the n avigatio n pane ,[...]
-
Page 388
12-60 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 2. Select an int erface and per form one of t he follo wing: — Click REFRESH to view the la test inte rf ace stat isti c s. — Click CLEAR All to reset all statisti cs to zero. — Click CLEAR to reset the s e lect ed i nter fa ce. 3. See T able 12-20 for a [...]
-
Page 389
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-61 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o di sp lay the D VMR P int erf ac e sta tis tics us ing the C LI, e nte r th e following command from configur ation mode: (configure)# show i p dvmrp interface Displaying DVMRP N eighbor Rout ers Web A g e n t Procedure T o view the DVMRP n eighbor ro uters using t[...]
-
Page 390
12-62 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o displa y th e DVMRP neighb or routers using th e CLI, enter the fol l owing command f rom configu r ation mode: (configure)# show ip dvmrp in terface n eighbors Displaying DVMRP Ro uting T able S tatistics DVMRP routing ta ble stati stics pr ovi[...]
-
Page 391
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-63 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-31 . DVM RP Route T able S tatistics W eb Page 2. See T able 12-22 for an explana tion of the DVMRP Route T able S tatisti cs W eb page par ameters: Displaying the DVMRP R oute T able The DVMRP route table contai ns in for mat ion on valid DVMRP routes, the expiry fo r t[...]
-
Page 392
12-64 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Figure 12- 32. DVMRP Route T able W eb Page 2. T o modify your DVMRP Route tabl e, do one of the f ollowing: — T o delete on e or more entries ., select the en try and click Delete Entry — T o clear the enti re table, cl ick Flush T able . — T o recei ve [...]
-
Page 393
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-65 Config uring IP Routing CLI Command T o display the DVM RP route ta ble using the CLI, enter the following command from con figuration mode: (configure)# show i p dvmrp routes Displaying the DVMRP U p stream Routers Web A g e n t Procedure T o view th e DVM RP ups trea m r out er s: 1. In the n avigatio [...]
-
Page 394
12-66 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Displaying the DVMRP Designated Forwarder(s) T able We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o view the DVMRP Desi gnated Forwarder table: 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Routing > DVMRP folders, an d then click R oute T able . The DVMRP Route T able W eb page i[...]
-
Page 395
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-67 Config uring IP Routing Displaying the DVMRP D ownstream Dependent Routers Web A g e n t Procedure T o view th e DVM RP dow ns t r ea m de pen d ent r out er s : 1. In the n avigatio n pane , expa nd the Routi ng > DVMRP folders, and t hen click Route T able . The D V M RP R out e T abl e W eb pag e i[...]
-
Page 396
12-68 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o displ ay the mult icast forwardi ng cache W eb pag e : 1. In the naviga tion pane, exp and the Routing > DVMRP folders, an d then click M ult ica st F or wa rdi ng C ach e . The Multi cast Forwarding Ca che W eb page is d ispla[...]
-
Page 397
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-69 Config uring IP Routing 4. Sele ct the number i n the Upstre am Interface is Pruned field. Th e Upstream Pr une Information W eb page is disp layed. 5. See T able 12-28 for an explanation of the Upstream Pru ne Information W eb page par ameters. Source Address Mask Subnet mask associated with the DVMRP s[...]
-
Page 398
12-70 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 6. Select the nu m ber in the Downstream In terface( s) field. The DVMRP Downstrea m Link(s) W e b page is displ ayed. 7. See T able 12-29 for a n explanation of the DVMRP Downstre am Links W eb pa ge parameters . Interface T ype The interface type. T ypes incl[...]
-
Page 399
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-71 Config uring IP Routing 8. Sele ct the number in t he Upstre am Sour ce (s ) field. The DVMRP Upstream Source(s ) W eb page is di splayed. 9. See T able 12-30 for an explanation of the DVMRP Upstream Source( s) W eb page par ameters. . Interface T ype Interface type. T ypes include: • Broad cast - All [...]
-
Page 400
12-72 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Configuring VRRP V irtual Route r Redundancy Protoc ol (VRRP) is used to provide fast -fail over for h osts if the d efa ult g atew ay fa ils. T his elimi nat es the s ing le po int of failur e inheren t in a network with statical ly config ured default route s[...]
-
Page 401
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-73 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-35 . IP Global Configura tion W eb Page 2. Sele ct Enab le fr om the VRRP fie ld pull-d own menu. 3. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. CLI Command T o globally enab le VRRP from the CLI, enter the fo llowing co m mand in Co[...]
-
Page 402
12-74 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o enable an VRRP on an interface using the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > Configurati on folde rs, an d th e n cli ck Interfaces . The IP In terfaces W eb page is displ ayed in the cont ent [...]
-
Page 403
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-75 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-37 . VRRP V irtual Route rs W eb Page 2. Sele ct C REA TE . The Add VRRP V irtua l Router W eb page opens ( Figure 1 2-38 ). Figure 12-38 . Add VRRP V irtual Router W e b Page 3. T a ble 12-31 lists th e para mete rs a nd d e scri bes th e ty pe o f i nfo rmat ion that s[...]
-
Page 404
12-76 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 T able 12-31. Add VRRP V irtual Router W eb Page Pa rameters Parameter Defi nition Interface This is the IP Interface that the virtual r outer will be associated with. The drop-do wn menu displays all the IP Interfaces currently created. Se lect the Interface t[...]
-
Page 405
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-77 Config uring IP Routing Advertisemen t Ti m e r Enter the value of the Advertisement In terval in seconds. This is the time interval that the router will sen d out advertisements if it is the Master . The range is from 1 - 255 seconds . The Advertisement I nterval also defines the time that a Backup will[...]
-
Page 406
12-78 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 4. Click CREA TE to save yo ur changes, or CANCEL to rest ore previous settin gs. CLI Command T o create a VRRP router from the CLI, enter the followin g command in Configur e mode: (config-if: <interface name> )# ip vrrp <vr-id> address <ip- add[...]
-
Page 407
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-79 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-39 . VRRP V irtual Route r St atistics W eb Page 2. T o modify the VRRP stat istics: — Click CLEAR to reset a ll th e e ntr ies . — Click REFRESH to recei ve th e most up-to -da te infor mation on the en trie s. 3. See T able 12-32 for an explan ation of the VRRP V i[...]
-
Page 408
12-80 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o view VRRP virt ual router sta tistics us ing the CLI, enter the following command in Use r mode: > show ip vrr p [cr | <if-na me> | <detail> ] VRRP Configurat ion Considerat ions Selecting VR ID numbers for Vi rtu al Routers The a[...]
-
Page 409
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-81 Config uring IP Routing Assigning the IP Address of a Virtual Router When creati ng a virtual ro uter , it must be fir st decide d whether to make th e IP Address of t he virt ual rout er (t he VIP) uni que or the same as the Primary IP A ddr es s of the asso c iate d IP In ter fac e ad dr ess . If t he [...]
-
Page 410
12-82 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 This is es pecially helpf ul in a network whe re a routing pro tocol is used (RIP , OSPF). In most case s, the VRRP ele ction pro cess will take plac e before the routing tabl e has been upda ted. This may cau se a longer p eriod of traf fic los s. Assigning Pr[...]
-
Page 411
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-83 Config uring IP Routing Configuring IRDP ICMP Router Dis covery Protocol ( IRDP) is an alternative rout er discovery protocol using ICMP messages on multicast links . ICMP uses router discovery messages, known as router a dvertisements a nd router soli cita tio ns. Each route r periodicall y multicasts a[...]
-
Page 412
12-84 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 2. Se lec t th e in te rfa ce o n w hi ch to e n able IRD P in th e Se le ct c olu m n. A checkmar k displays. 3. See T able 12-33 to co nfigure the ICMP Router Disc overy Protocol W eb page p ara m ete rs. T able 12-33. ICMP Rout er Discovery Prot ocol W eb Pa[...]
-
Page 413
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-85 Config uring IP Routing 4. Sele ct Enab le fr om the IRDP S tate pull-down menu. 5. Sele ct M ultic ast fr om t h e Adv . Addre ss pull-down menu. 6. Modify t he de faul t va lu e in the M in . Adv ert isem ent Inter val (sec .) field and e nter the m ini m um ti me in terv a l tha t pa ss es b efore the[...]
-
Page 414
12-86 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 Configuring LDAP Lightwei ght Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) al lows you to access the “Acc ess Cont rol L ist s”( A CLs) , re trie ve t he m f rom a data bas e on a n LDA P server , and apply th em to the A vaya P580 or P882 M ultiservi ce switches. Y ou[...]
-
Page 415
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-87 Config uring IP Routing Figure 12-41 . LDAP Configuration W eb Page 2. See T able 12-34 to configure the LDAP Conf iguration W eb page para mete rs. 3. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. T able 12-34. LDAP Configuration W eb Pag e Parameters Parameter Allows[...]
-
Page 416
12-88 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o configur e LDAP settings on a primary and sec ondary server , use the followi ng commands: ■ T o cha nge th e LD AP sear ch b a se, (configure)# ldap sear ch-base <search- base-DN> ■ T o change the primary LDAP serve r’ s primary ip [...]
-
Page 417
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-89 Config uring IP Routing Vie w i n g L D A P Stat is t i c s Y o u ca n vie w L D AP st atis tics fro m eith e r the W eb A gen t or t he CL I. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view LDA P st a tis tics usi ng th e W e b Age nt: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > Display fo ld ers , a[...]
-
Page 418
12-90 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12 CLI Command T o view co nfigurat ion and LDAP statis tics using the CLI , enter the followi ng command: > show ldap Configuring a S t atic R oute for the PPP Console We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o confi gure a PPP Cons ole static ro ute: 1. Configure your co[...]
-
Page 419
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 12-91 Config uring IP Routing Configuring the IP Interface for the PPP Console Y ou can configu re an IP interf ace for the PP P console from either the W eb Agent or th e CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o configure the PPP console wit h an IP address an d mask using the W eb Agent: 1. Configure your conso le s[...]
-
Page 420
12-92 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 12[...]
-
Page 421
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 13-1 13 Configuring Access List s Ove rview Contents This chapter contains the fo llowing secti ons: ■ Creatin g Access Rules ■ Enabling an Access List ■ Example: Us ing an Access Contr ol Rule to Filte r W eb T raffic ■ Logging ACL Act ivity ■ Opti mizin g S witch Pe[...]
-
Page 422
13-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 13 These fi ve parameters are referred to as a “5 T uple”. Sour ce or dest ination address es allow you to pri oritize traf fic between a ny combination of host, subnet, a nd network address es. Further , if you specif y a source or des tination TCP/UDP port ,[...]
-
Page 423
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-3 Configur ing Access Lis ts An ACL name can be a number . For exampl e, you can c reate a list whose name is 1 or 151. If you chose t o use numbers , keep in mind the f ollowing rest rict ion s: ■ Numbers 1 t hrough 99 are r eserved f or Stand ard type Rul es ONLY . So, for ex ample, if you try t o creat[...]
-
Page 424
13-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 13 What is TCP Est ablished? TCP Establish ed is a cr iteria appl ied by a r ule where t he “Acknowle dge” bit in a TC P h e ade r is e xami ned . If th is op tion is not “chec ke d”, th e ru le wil l apply to the pac kets whose Ackno wledge bi t is cl ear[...]
-
Page 425
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-5 Configur ing Access Lis ts The rules for implementi ng the above re strict ions would be as follows: Rules 1 and 2 collectively m anage W eb tr aff ic to and from the W eb serve r (WS). Rule 1 says tha t any source addr ess can get to t he W eb se rver ’ s IP address us ing destinati on port 80. Because[...]
-
Page 426
13-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 13 Creatin g Ac ce ss Rul es This sec t ion contains t he followi ng procedu res: ■ Creating S tandard Access Rules ■ Creating E xtended Access Rules Creating St a ndard Access Rules T o create s tandard access rules: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Ro[...]
-
Page 427
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-7 Configur ing Access Lis ts Figure 13-1. IP Access List W e b Page 2. Clic k Create S tandard . The Crea te St andard Access List W eb pag e is displaye d. See Figur e 13-2 . Figure 13-2. Create IP S tan dard Access Lis t W eb Page 3. See Ta b l e 1 3 - 1 to confi gur e th e Cr ea te Stan da rd IP A c ces [...]
-
Page 428
13-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 13 4. Click CREA TE to save yo ur changes, or CANCEL to re store pr evious settin gs. Creating Extended Acc ess Rules T o create E xtended Access Rules: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > Configurati on folde rs, an d th e n cli ck Access[...]
-
Page 429
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-9 Configur ing Access Lis ts *Note: Th e IP Access List W eb page disp lays all standa rd and extended access rule s that have been c reated. If no ru les have been created, the fol lowing statement displays: No IP Access Rules are currently configured . 2. Sele ct C reate Ex ten d ed . The IP Extended A cc[...]
-
Page 430
13-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 T a ble 13- 2. IP Exte nd ed Ac cess Rule Cr eati on Pa ra mete rs Parameter Allows you to... Access List Name Enter the alphanumeric name of the access list this rule will be added to. S ee “ N ami ng Co nve nti ons for ACLs ” for m ore information Access [...]
-
Page 431
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-11 Configur ing Access Lis ts TCP/UD P Sourc e Po rt Specify a range of s ource ports that p ass between two hosts or swit ches usi ng the T ransmis sion Control P rotocol (TCP) or the User Datagram Protocol (UDP). Options inclu de: • Min. - The lowest numbered port in the ran ge. The default is 0. • Ma[...]
-
Page 432
13-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 Enablin g an Access List Y ou can enable an access li st on the switch through t he W eb Agent and t he CLI. When you enab le an ACL, the switch: ■ May change the maximum numbe r of forwarding e ntries for IP unic ast traffic to imp rov e the perfo rma n ce o[...]
-
Page 433
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-13 Configur ing Access Lis ts 2. Sele ct Enab le fr om the Enable field pull-down m enu to f i lter inbound traffic. 3. Select the n ame of th e ac ce ss l ist to be u s ed f or fi lter ing w hen IP acc ess cont rol i s en ab led fro m the IP Ac ce ss L ist field pul l-down menu. 4. Clic k APPL Y to save yo[...]
-
Page 434
13-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 7. En ter the IP add r e ss in the D est Add ress field that represen ts the destin ation address of the W eb serve r . Enter a wil dcard of 0 .0.0.0 to ident ify t he spe cif ic IP a ddr ess of the destin ati on W e b serv er . * Note: T o deny/filter traffic [...]
-
Page 435
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-15 Configur ing Access Lis ts 3. Enter a number between 100 and 199 (or Alph anumeric) (extended ACL) in th e Access List Name field to id en tify y our new a cce ss con tro l list. 4. Enter a number in th e Access Rule Index fi le to id enti fy th e acce ss r ule . 5. Sele ct D eny/F il te r from the Acces[...]
-
Page 436
13-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 ■ Forwarding inf or mati on: — The p rio ri ty o f the pack et if the A C L as sign s it a pri ority and forwards it. — Forward with no change in priority if the ACL forwards the packet withou t changing it s priority . — FILTER if the ACL blocks the pa[...]
-
Page 437
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-17 Configur ing Access Lis ts CLI Command To enable ACL logg ing, use the foll owing CLI command: (configure)# ip ac l-logging en able <acc ess-lis t-name> <rul e- number> To disabl e ACL logging, use the following CLI command: (configure)# ip ac l-logging disabl e <access-li st-name> <[...]
-
Page 438
13-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 CLI Command T o set the interval fo r ACL logging , use the foll owing CLI command: (configure)# ip acl -logging logg ing-inte rval <tim e-in -seco nds> Optimizing Switch Performance Overview * Note: Thi s section provi des a det ailed discussi on of the [...]
-
Page 439
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-19 Configur ing Access Lis ts ■ DA : Destinati on IP Add res s. ■ F-chip : F orwarding-chip ( F-chip) is an ap plication spec ific integr ated circuit ( ASIC) that forwar ds recognized pac kets via Fast Path or u nrecognized packe ts via Slow Path. It l earns or flush es L3 forwardi ng entri e s (L3FE) [...]
-
Page 440
13-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 the CPU for pr ocessing and for warding. Once the CPU h as determine d the destinati on, it updates t he L3 forwarding cache on the F-chi ps with the L3FE. On ce updated , the F-chip can f orward futu re p acket s vi a Fa st Pat h. ■ SA : Source I P Address. [...]
-
Page 441
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-21 Configur ing Access Lis ts Once you have determined th at the ACL is the root cau se, and have optimiz ed the rul es, you need t o tune system pa ramete rs. Evaluating System Performan ce The first step is to determine whether the use of an ACL aff ects system performanc e. This requires an analysis of t[...]
-
Page 442
13-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 How Many Cac he Entr ies? Each F-chip/PRE (s ee “ Iden tify in g th e Por ts ” later i n this cha pter for PRE column explanation) r eserves s pace for IP uni cast, IP m ultic ast, and IPX. By defaul t, the number of ent r ies are limited to 15,000 for each[...]
-
Page 443
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-23 Configur ing Access Lis ts Figure 13-7. Active FE Cache W eb page Enabling Ro uting at th e Module The P580 and P88 2 have the opti on of cent ralized (unli censed) or distrib uted (li censed) routing function. When a modul e is licensed, the on- board F-Chi ps (FIRE) pr ovide the fast- path proc essing.[...]
-
Page 444
13-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 Designing Safe, Efficient AC Ls The entr y of ACL rules via the CLI , W eb or A vaya Poli cy Manager does not encou rage or enfor ce any chec king beyond corre ct syntax. The gene ral guideli ne is that you ar e configuring a Layer-3 swi t ch, not a fire w all.[...]
-
Page 445
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-25 Configur ing Access Lis ts Identifyin g the Port s The chassi s is organi zed by slots, fa bric ports, PREs or F-chips, and physical ports. The number of F-Chips and phys ical ports var ies accordi ng to the module type. This i nformation helps you distribute the worklo ad evenly among resources and id e[...]
-
Page 446
13-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 Conf iguring Ha sh Mode If your diagnosis shows a p erformance degra dation with an ACL ena bled, IP Unicast Has h mode may need to b e changed from DA-only to SA-DA . When you enab le an ACL, the switch automatically s ets hash mod e for IP unica st traf fic t[...]
-
Page 447
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-27 Configur ing Access Lis ts SA- DA m o de ca n ca us e a n otic e abl e inc r eas e in t he to t al fl ows id en tifie d and resul t in an increase d usage of F-chip memory . See “ Manag i ng F-chip Memory ” in th is case. *Import ant: Cha nging the Has h Mode setting a ffec ts every L3- enabled F-chi[...]
-
Page 448
13-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13 dif ferent iate packe ts by protoc ol and port. Th ese entri es all hash to the same value be cause they have t he same source and de stination addres s, and you may observe a degradation o f the switch perf ormance. Examp le T o block SNMP acce ss to the super[...]
-
Page 449
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 13-29 Configur ing Access Lis ts T o view the current total number of e ntries for the CPU, expand the Routing > L3 For warding Cache fold ers , and the n clic k Cache Configurati on . The T otal Curre nt Entries field dis pla ys the cur ren t to tal entr ies f or the CPU . T o view the current total number[...]
-
Page 450
13-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 13[...]
-
Page 451
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 14-1 14 Configuring RIP Rout ing Ove rview * Note: T o glob all y en able the Routin g Inf or mati on Pr oto col (RIP), see Chapter 1 2 , “ Confi guring IP Ro uting .” The inform ation and proced ures provid ed in this chapte r pertain to 50- series layer 3, a nd licensed 8[...]
-
Page 452
14-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 14 Figure 14- 1. RIP Global C onfigur ation W eb Page 2. See T able 14-1 to con figure the RIP Glo bal Configuration W eb page para meters 3. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. T able 14-1. RIP Gl obal Configur ation W eb [...]
-
Page 453
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 14-3 Config uring RIP Routing CLI Commands T o configure or modify the RI P parameter s globally on you r switch using the CLI, ent er the followin g commands in r outer:r ip mode: ■ (configure router:rip)# ti mers basic <update> <invalid> ■ (configure router:rip)# out put-delay <delay> ?[...]
-
Page 454
14-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 14 3. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. T able 14-2. RIP In terface W eb Page Pa rameters Parameter Allo w s you to... Select Select the RIP in terface to be modified. Interface Displays an interface from a list of interf[...]
-
Page 455
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 14-5 Config uring RIP Routing CLI Command T o mo dify R IP i nte rf ace s pa ra me te rs us ing th e C L I en te r the foll o win g command from Conf igure mode: (configure)# interfa ce <intf-name> | [type {mbna | ethernet}] Default Metric Specify the RIP route metric v alue. Costing metric used when adv[...]
-
Page 456
14-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 14 Creating T rusted RIP Neighbors T rusted RIP n eighbors enable you to enhance the switch’ s security by enablin g one or more neighbo rs to relay RIP informat ion. * Note: Add i ng one or more tru sted RIP nei ghbors ens ures that your router accepts only in [...]
-
Page 457
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 14-7 Config uring RIP Routing Figure 14-4. Add T rusted RIP Neighbors W eb Page 6. En ter the I P address for t he node that acts as t he trusted RIP n eighbor in Network Address fi eld. 7. Clic k APPL Y to save your changes, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. CLI Command T o cr eate a trus ted RIP n[...]
-
Page 458
14-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 14 Key Chains on the A vaya Mul tiservice Switch The A vaya Multis ervice swi tch supports t he creation of a single Key Chain with a si ngle Key . Hence, Key and Key Ch ain are interc hangeable term s. The Key has a setting fo r a star t time and durati on. Regar[...]
-
Page 459
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 14-9 Config uring RIP Routing Figure 14-5. Key Chain W eb Page 2. Con figure t he key chai n as appropriat e. See T able 14-3 for an explanat ion of each fiel d. 3. Clic k APPL Y to save your changes, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. T ab le 14-3. Key Chain Parameters Parameter Defines the... Key C[...]
-
Page 460
14-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 14 CLI Commands T o assign or modify K ey Chain parameter s using the CLI, enter th e followi ng commands fr om router:rip mode: ■ T o crea te th e Ke y C ha in: (configure router:rip)# key ch ain <Key Chain> ■ T o set t he Ke y Cha in ID : (configure ro[...]
-
Page 461
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 14-11 Config uring RIP Routing Vi e w i n g RI P Sta t i s t i c s Y ou can view RIP st atisti cs using either the W eb Agent or the CLI . Web A g e n t Procedure T o view RIP sta tisti cs u si ng t he W e b A gent: 1. In th e navigation pa ne, expand the Routing > IP > RIP folders, and then click Inter [...]
-
Page 462
14-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 14 CAUTION: CLI Command T o v iew R IP s tati stic s usin g the CL I, ent er the foll owin g co m man d fr om Configur e mode: (configure)# show ip rip sta t istics NBMA IP Interfaces Non-broad cast multi-access (NBMA) functionality wa s added to RIP an d OSPF rou[...]
-
Page 463
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 15-1 15 Configur ing the OSPF Routing Protoc ol Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 3 module configu ration on ly: ■ What is OSPF? ■ Conf igu rin g OS P F ■ Monitori ng Switch Performance Us ing OSPF Stati stic[...]
-
Page 464
15-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 15 sum mari ze th e n et wo rks i n thei r are as a nd ad ver tise them ont o the backbone ar ea. The bac kbone, in turn, di stri butes t he inf ormatio n to the other areas. ■ Backbone Router — a router that has at lease one di rectly connected network in the[...]
-
Page 465
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-3 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Configurin g the OSPF Glob al Config urat ion The OSPF global configuration allows you to glob ally configure OSPF on your switc h. I t als o a llows you to spec ify your router ID and whether or not you want the switch to be the Autonomous System (AS) bo rde[...]
-
Page 466
15-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 15 2. See T able 15-1 to con figure the OSPF Globa l Configuratio n W eb page para meters. 3. Click APPL Y to save cha nges, or CANCEL to rest ore previ ous sett ings. T able 15-1. OSPF Glob al Configuration W eb Page Parameters Parameter Expla nation OSPF Select [...]
-
Page 467
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-5 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CLI Command T o globally conf igure OSPF , use the foll owing command: (configure)# r outer ospf Creating OSPF Areas Y ou can create OSPF areas using ei ther the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o create OSPF a reas usin g the W eb Agent: 1. I[...]
-
Page 468
15-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Figure 15- 3. ADD OSPF Area W eb Page 3. See T able 15-2 to con figure the Add OSPF Are a W eb page para m eters. 4. Click CREA TE to save yo ur changes, or CANCEL to re store pr evious settin gs. T able 15-2. Add OSPF Are a W eb Page Paramet ers Parameter Allo[...]
-
Page 469
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-7 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CLI Command T o create OSPF areas, u se the fol lowing CLI command: (configure router:ospf)# ar e a <area-id> <option> * Note: If you use the network ar ea CLI command to add an interface to an OSP F area, be c areful not t o enter t he IP mask fo[...]
-
Page 470
15-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Modifying OSPF Areas Y ou can modif y the para meters o f an OSPF area usi ng either the W eb Agent or the CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o modify an OSPF area us ing the W eb Agent : 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > OSPF folders [...]
-
Page 471
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-9 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Modifying OSPF In terfaces Y ou can modify th e parameters on an OSPF inte rface using either t he W eb Agent or th e CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o modify an OSPF i nterface using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e, expand Routing > IP > Con[...]
-
Page 472
15-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 11 . Re ena b le th e inte rfac e: a. In the navigati on pane, expand Rou ting > IP > Configurati on folde rs. b. Clic k Interfa ces . The IP Int erfaces W eb page is displ ayed in the co ntent pane. c. Selec t the Select check box f or the interface t ha[...]
-
Page 473
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-11 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CLI Command T o modify an OSPF inte rface using the CLI, enter the fo llowing command: (configure router:ospf)# ne twork <ip-address> <wil dcard- mask> <area-id> If you use the network a rea CLI command to add an int erface to an OSPF area [...]
-
Page 474
15-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Configuring an OSPF Passiv e-Interface Y ou can prevent OSPF f rom sen d in g rou ti ng upda tes across th e net work by usin g the OSPF passi ve-interface c omm and. Enablin g t his command prevent s OSPF from sending hel lo packets acro ss the network. Any OS[...]
-
Page 475
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-13 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Figure 15-5. OSPF V irtual Links W e b Page 2. Sele ct C REA TE . The Add OSPF V irtu a l Link W eb page is displayed. See Fig ure 15-6 . Figure 15-6. Add OSPF V irtual Link W eb Page 3. Enter the new OSPF Link in formati on. See T able 15- 4 for an expl ana[...]
-
Page 476
15-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 CLI Command T o create a OSPF virtual link, us e the following c ommand: (configure router:ospf)# ar ea <a rea-i d> virt ual-link < route r- id> T able 15-4. Add OSPF V irtual Link W eb Page Paramete rs Parameter De fines the ... Router ID Router ID[...]
-
Page 477
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-15 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Deleting O SPF V irt ual Links Y ou can delete OSPF V irtual l i nks using eith er the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o delete an O SPF virtual li nk using the W e b Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > OSPF [...]
-
Page 478
15-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Creating OSPF Summaries The primar y purpose of the OSP F summary is route ag gregatio n. Route aggregat ion is a grou p range of IP addresses tha t are linked to a single addr ess. Y ou can creat e a new OSPF summary from eit her the W eb Agent or the CLI. We [...]
-
Page 479
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-17 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col 3. See Ta b l e 1 5 - 5 for details about the Add OSPF Summary W eb page para mete rs: 4. Clic k CREA TE to sav e the n ew OSPF summar y , or CANCEL to ignore the new summar y . CLI Command T o create a new OSPF summary , use the followi ng command: (configu[...]
-
Page 480
15-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Modifying OSPF Sum maries Y ou can modify a n OSPF summary using with er the W eb Agent or the CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o modify an OSPF summary using the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IP > OSPF folders , and then [...]
-
Page 481
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-19 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Displaying OSPF St atistics Y ou can displa y OSPF statistics using eit her the W eb Agen t or the CLI . Web A g e n t Procedure T o display t he OSPF global st atisti cs using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IP > OSP[...]
-
Page 482
15-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 CLI Commands T o display the OSPF gl obal statist i cs using the CLI, use the foll owing commands: ■ > sh ow ip osp f sta t s ■ > show ip ospf virtual-links OSPF V ersi on Current vers ion of OS PF . The P580/P88 2 with Integrated Routin g sup ports O[...]
-
Page 483
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-21 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Displaying OSPF Li nks The OSPF link d isplay provides information on t he currently ac tive OSPF links. Y ou can display t he OSPF using e ither the W e b Agent or the CLI . Web A g e n t Procedure T o display OSPF l inks using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he na[...]
-
Page 484
15-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Displaying OSPF Neighbors The OSPF neigh bors table summa ri zes th e list of OSPF inte rfaces and thei r associa ted neighbors . Y ou can displa y OSPF neighbors usi ng either the W eb Agent or t he CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o display the OSPF neighbor[...]
-
Page 485
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-23 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CLI Command T o display the OSPF neighbors using t he CLI, enter t he following command: > show ip os pf neighbor T able 15-8. OSPF Neighbors W eb Page Parameters Parameter Definition IP Address The IP address associated with the OSPF neighb or . State Th[...]
-
Page 486
15-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 Searching the OSPF Lin k St ate Dat abas e Y ou can sear ch t he OSPF kink sta te dat aba se using either t he W eb Agent or the C L I. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o sear ch the OSPF li nk state databa se using the W eb Age nt: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa[...]
-
Page 487
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-25 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col 4. If y our search produc es results, the detailed info rmation displays in the OSPF Link S tate Database W eb page ( Figure 15-13 ). Figure 15-13 . OSPF Link S tate Dat abase W eb Page 5. See T able 15-10 for an explanation of the OSPF Link S tate Database [...]
-
Page 488
15-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 6. T o upd ate all L SA en tri es in th e da tab ase , sele ct Refresh T able . 7. T o di splay the d eta ils of a spe cifi c li nk st ate a dve rtis eme nt (L SA) , se lect Details from t he Detail Link c olumn The L SA Detail W eb page displa ys with addition[...]
-
Page 489
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-27 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col Figure 15-14 . LSA Detail W eb Page 8. See Ta b l e 1 5 - 1 1 f or an explanatio n of the LSA Detail W eb page para mete rs. T able 15-1 1. LSA Det ail W eb Page Par ameters Parameter Defini tion Area Displays the 32-bit identifier of the area from which the[...]
-
Page 490
15-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 9. T o upd ate the L S A e n try , sel ect Refr es h En try . CLI Command T o search t he OSPF link sta te databa se using the CLI, e nter the follo w ing command: > show ip ospf database <options> NBMA IP Interfaces Overview Non-broad cast multi-acces[...]
-
Page 491
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-29 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CAUTION: The NBMA feature is not backward compat ibl e. If you have NBM A interface s set up and nee d to down grade from v 6.1 to a 5.2 version of soft w are, cont act technical support . This sect ion contains pro cedures for t he foll owing tasks: ■ Set[...]
-
Page 492
15-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15 7. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. *Note: Y ou m ust br ing the I P inte rfa ce Do wn to suc ces sful ly enable OSPF on the IP interfa ce. If you do not, yo u will get an error message and OSPF will not be enabled . [...]
-
Page 493
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 15-31 Con figur in g th e OS PF R outi ng P roto col CLI Commands T o set up NBMA nei ghbors on OSPF , you must first creat e an OSPF inte rfac e. After you c reate an OSPF in terface , use the foll owing command t o set up NBMA neighbors: (configure router:ospf)# nbma- neighbor <ip addr ess> Removing NB[...]
-
Page 494
15-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 15[...]
-
Page 495
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 16-1 16 Configuring IPX Routi ng Ove rview This chapt er provides t he follo wing informati on and procedures for configuri ng layer 2 modules or licensed la yer 3 modules. Se e Chapter 1 “ Intr oduction ” for mor e details about routing IP and I nternetwork Packe t Exchang[...]
-
Page 496
16-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 16 IPX Dat a gram Structure The IPX d atagram contai ns an IPX header and any data to be t ra nsf er re d on the netwo rk. The IPX header i s a 30 byte header that contains 1 0 fields. Figure 16 - 1 illus trates a conceptual vie w of an I PX datagram: Figure 16- 1[...]
-
Page 497
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-3 Config uring IPX R outing Configuring the A vaya Switch as an IPX Router Y ou can configu r e the A vaya P580 or P882 Multi service switch as an IPX router . Specifi c hardware is require d to accomplis h this configur ation. This sect ion contains the foll owing informat ion and procedu res: ■ Hardware[...]
-
Page 498
16-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 16 Hardware Requirement s T o configur e your switch as an IPX rou ter , your A vaya P580 or P882 Multiser vice swit ch must be configur ed with the fol lowing hardware: ■ Layer 3 50- series media mo dules. ■ 80-Series Supervisor Module s ■ 80-Series License[...]
-
Page 499
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-5 Config uring IPX R outing CLI Commands T o enable IPX routi ng globally using the CLI, enter the fol lowing command from Configu re mode: ■ T o e nable IPX r out ing glo ba lly , (configure)# ipx routing ■ T o disable IPX rou ti ng gl obal ly , (configure)# no ipx rou ti ng Configurin g IPX Interfaces[...]
-
Page 500
16-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 16 Figure 16- 3. IPX Inter f aces W eb Page 2. T o crea te a new IP X in terf ace C lick o n CREA TE . * Note: Only the crea te bu tton is sho w n if no IP X Inte rfa ces a re configu red. The Add IPX i nterface W eb page is displayed. Se e Figure 16-4 Figure 16- [...]
-
Page 501
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-7 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-5. IPX Interfaces W eb Page *Note: D ue to its le ngt h, the IPX In terf aces W eb pa ge is sp lit in to two views. 5. T o view or modify IPX Interf aces, expand the Routi ng > IPX > Configurat ion folders in t he navigat ion pane, and then click Interfac es . The[...]
-
Page 502
16-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 16 T able 16-3. IPX In terface W eb Page Paramet ers Parameter Allows you to... Select Select the Interface to be config ured. This field id displayed in the IPX Interfaces W eb page not in the Add Interfaces W eb page. Admin. St ate Select the administration stat[...]
-
Page 503
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-9 Config uring IPX R outing CLI Command T o begin the cre ation of a new IPX interface using the CLI, ent er the following command in Configure mod e: (configure)# interf ace <interface name> Creating IPX S t atic Routes Y ou can create IPX stati c routes using eit her the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A[...]
-
Page 504
16-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 2. T o create a new IPX S tatic Route, c lick CREA TE . * Note: Only the crea te bu tton is s ho wn if no I PX Stati c Rou tes are configu red. The Add IPX S tatic Route W eb page is dis played. See Figure 16-7 . Figure 16- 7. Add IPX S tatic Route W eb Page 3.[...]
-
Page 505
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-11 Config uring IPX R outing 4. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. 5. T o view or modify IPX Sta t ic Routes, expan d the Routing > IPX > Configurat ion folders in t he navigat ion pane, and then click St a t i c Routes . The IPX S tatic Routes W eb page [...]
-
Page 506
16-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 CLI Command T o d ele te an IP X sta tic rou t e usin g the CL I, ent er the foll ow in g co m man d from Configur e mode: (configure)# clea r ipx rout e { <netw ork > default | *} Modifying IPX St atic Routes Y ou can modi fy IPX stat ic routes form e it[...]
-
Page 507
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-13 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-9. IPX static Se rvices W eb Page 2. Sele ct C REA TE to crea te a n ew st atic ser vice . The A dd IP X Stat ic Service W eb page is d i splayed. See Figu re 16-10 . * Note: O n ly t he Cr eate bu tto n is show n if no I PX Stati c S erv ice s a re configur ed. Figure[...]
-
Page 508
16-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 4. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. 5. T o vi ew or modi fy IP X Stat i c Se rvic es, e xpa nd t h e Routing > IPX > Configura t ion fold ers in the na vigation pane, and then c lick St a t i c Service s . The I[...]
-
Page 509
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-15 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-1 1. IPX S tatic Servi ces W eb Page CLI Command T o create IPX stat ic servic es usin g the CLI, ente r the foll owing command in Con fig ure mo de: (configure)# ipx servic e <ser vic e- typ e type | ran g e> Deleting IPX St atic Service Y ou can delete an IPX s[...]
-
Page 510
16-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 2. Select the c heckbox for the I PX Static Ser vice that you want to modify from the Select column. 3. See T able 16-5 to m odify the IPX S tatic Servic es W eb page para m eters . CLI Command T o m o dif y an IP X s ta tic s erv ice us ing the C LI, e nter th[...]
-
Page 511
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-17 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-12 . IPX Global S tat istics Dialogue Box 2. T o vie w the latest sta tist ics a vai la ble , clic k REFR ESH to upda te al l statis tics. 3. T o reset all of the statisti cs that are cur rently displa yed, click CLEAR. The s tat is tics all r ese t to zer o. 4. See Ta[...]
-
Page 512
16-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 CLI Command T o display the global IPX routing s tatistics use t he following command: > show ipx t raffic Searching the IPX Rou te T able T o search t he IPX route tabl e: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IPX > Display folders, and th[...]
-
Page 513
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-19 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-13 . IPX Route T a ble Search W eb Page 2. Sele ct the SEARCH Criteria you w ant to use to f ind informatio n on specifi c rout es. F or exampl e, if yo u want to f ind al l sta tic ro utes t hat ar e presentl y configur ed on your switch, sea rch by source and spe cif[...]
-
Page 514
16-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 Displaying the IPX Route T able T o display the IPX route tabl e: 1. Perform an IPX Route T able search as described in “ Searchin g th e IPX Route T able .” If avai lable r outes are found the y are dis played in the IPX Route T able W eb page. 2. See T ab[...]
-
Page 515
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-21 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-14 . IPX Route T a ble S tatist ics W eb Page 2. See Ta b l e 1 6 - 9 and review each statistic: Searching the I PX Service T able T o sear ch th e IPX serv ice tabl e : 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IPX > Di splay fo l der s, and then c lick[...]
-
Page 516
16-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 Figure 16- 15. IPX Service T able Search W eb Pag e 2. Select the search criter ia you want to use to find infor m ation on speci fic servic es in the Search By column. For example, i f you want to fin d all stat ic ser vice s th at are pres ent ly c on fig ure[...]
-
Page 517
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-23 Config uring IPX R outing 4. Clic k on the SEARCH to st art the s ear ch . — If avail able servi ces are foun d they are displ ayed in IPX Ser vice T able W eb page. — If ser vices are not a vailable, a mes sage disp lays in the IPX Serv ice T abl e W eb page . Displaying the IPX Service T able T o d[...]
-
Page 518
16-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16 Displaying IPX Service T ab le St atistics T o d ispla y th e IP X serv i ce ta ble stat is tics : 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IPX > Display folders, and then click Servic e T able S tatis tics . The IPX Ser vice T able S tatistics W[...]
-
Page 519
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 16-25 Config uring IPX R outing Figure 16-16 . IPX Service T able S tatis tics 2. See T able 16-12 to revie w eac h stat is ti c: T ab le 16-12. I PX Service T able S tati stics W eb Page S tat isti c Defines the ... Current Number of Services The current number o f IPX services. Peak Number of Services The pe[...]
-
Page 520
16-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 16[...]
-
Page 521
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 17-1 17 Configur ing the IPX RIP Protocol Ove rview The informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 3 module co nfigurat ion only . This cha pter provides i nformation abo ut the Inte rne twork Pa cke t E xch ange (IP X) Ro uti ng I nte rf ace Pro t[...]
-
Page 522
17-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 17 Figure 17- 1. IPX RIP Interfaces W eb Page 2. See T able 17-1 to m odify the IPX RIP Interface s W eb page paramet ers. 3. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. T able 17-1. IPX RIP Interfaces W eb Page Pa rameters Paramet[...]
-
Page 523
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 17-3 Config uring the IPX RIP Protocol CL Command T o c onfigure IPX RIP interface s using the CLI , enter th e following command in Int erface mode: (config-if: <if name> )# ipx rip Creating and Modify ing IPX RIP Filters Y ou can create and modi fy IPX RIP filte rs from eith er the W eb Agent or the CL[...]
-
Page 524
17-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 17 Figure 17- 2. IPX RIP Filt ers W eb Page 2. Select CREA TE to crea te a new filter . The Add IPX RIP Filter W eb page is displayed. See Figure 17- 3 . Figure 17- 3. Add IPX RIP Fil t er W eb Page 3. See T able 17-2 to modi f y th e Add IPX R I P F ilte r W eb p[...]
-
Page 525
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 17-5 Config uring the IPX RIP Protocol T able 17-2. Add IPX RIP Filter s W eb Page Pa rameters Parameter Allows yo u to... Select The Select chechbox sel ects the IPX Interface. This box only appears with the IPX RIP Filters W eb page. Interface Select the interface to which this filter will be applied to RIP [...]
-
Page 526
17-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 17 Example # 1: Configuri ng your switch to su ppress adve rtising of network 10 T o confi gure your s witch to suppr ess the a dvertising of netw ork 10 on the IPX i nte rf ace nam e d Ba ckbo ne , co m ple te the foll owin g st eps : 1. In the naviga tion pane, [...]
-
Page 527
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 17-7 Config uring the IPX RIP Protocol 4. Clic k Apply to save yo ur changes, or CANCEL to r estore pr evious setting s. The filte r crea ted in thi s exa mpl e en su res that al l ad ver tisi ng of n e two r k 10 from th e interface la beled Backbone is suppres sed. Example #2: Suppr ess Advertis ing of all N[...]
-
Page 528
17-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 17 c. Enter 0 in th e S tart Network fiel d. d. Enter ffffffff in the End Network field . e. Select Outbound fro m the Dir ecti on pull -down menu. f. Select Ena ble from th e Filter/Suppr ess pull-down men u. g. Enter 0 in the Ticks and Hops field s. 3. Click APP[...]
-
Page 529
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 17-9 Config uring the IPX RIP Protocol CLI Command T o inte rpr et IP X RIP i nte rfac e st at isti cs u sing t he CL I, e n ter t he fol low in g command fr om Interface mode: (config-if <interface name> )# show ipx interface [ <intf- name> ] T ab le 17-3. IP X RIP Inter face S tati stical Paramet[...]
-
Page 530
17-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 17[...]
-
Page 531
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 18-1 18 Configuring the IPX SAP Protocol Ove rview The informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 3 module co nfigurat ion only . This cha pter provides i nformation abo ut the Internet work Packet Exchang e (IPX) Service Adve rtisin g Protocol (SA[...]
-
Page 532
18-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Figure 18- 1. IPX SAP Inter faces W eb Page 2. See T able 18-1 to conf igu re th e IPX S AP In ter fac e W eb pag e para meters. 3. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to restore previous settin gs. T able 18-1. IPX SAP I nterface W eb Page Parameters[...]
-
Page 533
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-3 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol CLI Command T o configure the IPX SAP interfa ces using the CLI, enter the fo llowing command fr om Interface mode: (config-if <interface-name> )# ipx sap Creating IPX SAP Filters This sect ion provides t he following pro cedures: ■ Creatin g IPX SAP Name Filters [...]
-
Page 534
18-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Creating IPX SAP Name Filters Y ou can creat e IPX SAP name filter suing ei ther the W e b Agent or the CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o c r e ate IPX S AP na me fi lter s us ing th e W eb Agen t: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IPX >[...]
-
Page 535
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-5 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol 3. Conf ig ure an IPX S AP na me fil ter . S e e T able 18-2 for an expl ana tio n of the Add IPX SAP Na m e Filter W eb pa ge parameters 4. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. T able 18- 2. IPX SAP Name Filter W eb Page Param[...]
-
Page 536
18-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Example: Suppr ess Advert ising of all Pr int Server s on Interface Remote T o confi gure your s witch to su ppress the adverti sing of al l Print Se rvers (f or example, t ype 7) on Interf ace Remote: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > IPX &g[...]
-
Page 537
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-7 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol f. Selec t Enable fr o m the Filter/Su ppress pull-down m enu. g. Enter 0 in t he Hops fie ld. T his ens ure s tha t th ere i s no over ride in the tran smission of data on the network. 4. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re previ ous setting s. * [...]
-
Page 538
18-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Figure 18- 5. Add IPX SAP Net Fi lter W eb Page 3. See T able 18-3 to con figure the Add IPX SAP N et Fil ters W eb pa ge para meters. 4. Click APPL Y to save your c hanges, or CANCEL to rest ore previous settin gs. T able 18-3. Add IP X SAP Network Fi lter W e[...]
-
Page 539
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-9 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol T ype Specify the service type (i n hex) that identifies the typ e of service the server provides. W ell-known service types include: • Unknown (0) • Print Queu e (3) • File Server (4) • Job S erver (5) • Print S erver (7) • Archive Server (9 ) • Remote Bri [...]
-
Page 540
18-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Filteri ng all Services Except Netwar e Dir ectory Se rvices (NDS) T o confi gure your s witch to fil ter all services e xcept NDS a speci fic Inter fac e, yo u mus t cre ate tw o fi lt ers. T og eth e r , Filt er 1 a n d Fi lt er 2 filte r service s learned on[...]
-
Page 541
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-11 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol Filter 2 Filter 2 ensures that all net works and servi ce types are filter ed for the indic ated inte rface. 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > IPX > SAP folders, and then cli ck Net Filters . The IPX SAP Net Fi lters W eb page is displ ayed in t he[...]
-
Page 542
18-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 18 Interpre ting I PX SAP In terface St atis tics Y o u can interp ret IPX SA P int erfa ce st atisti cs u sing ei the r the W eb Age nt or the C L I. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o i nter p ret I PX SA P i nte rf ace stat isti c us in g th e W eb Agen t: 1. In th[...]
-
Page 543
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 18-13 Configuri ng the IPX SAP Protocol CLI Command T o interpret I PX SAP interface st atistics usi ng the CLI, enter t he following command fr om Interface mode: (config-if <interface name> )# show ipx inte rface [ <intf- name> ] Non-triggered Updates Sent Th e number of non- triggere d updates s[...]
-
Page 544
18-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 18[...]
-
Page 545
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 19-1 19 Configuring Apple T alk Routing Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 3 module configu ration on ly: ■ Impl em entat ion ■ Configur ing AppleT alk Routing ■ V iewing AppleT alk S tatisti cs For more infor[...]
-
Page 546
19-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 19 The A vaya P580 and P882 Multiservi ce switches supp ort the following AppleT alk pr otocols: ■ AppleT alk Addre ss Resolution Pr otocol (AARP) This is an AppleT alk support pr otocol t hat maps the hardwar e address of an AppleT alk node to an Appletalk prot[...]
-
Page 547
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-3 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Need for App leT alk Routin g If you conf igure your A vaya P580 or P882 Mul tiserv ice switch into a network running Appl eT alk routing, you should be aware of the following : ■ Appletal k is built int o all Appl e devices, thus maki ng them automati cally network ca p[...]
-
Page 548
19-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 19 Enabling A ppleT alk Glo bal Routing T o enable Appl eT alk routing globally: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing > Apple T alk > Configura t ion fold ers, and then c lick Global Conf iguration . The Apple T alk Routi ng Global Configu ration [...]
-
Page 549
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-5 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng 3. Select CREA TE . The Add AppleT alk Inte rf ace s W eb page is displ aye d. See Fig ure 19-3 . Figure 19-3. Add AppleT alk Interfaces W eb Page 4. See Ta b l e 1 9 - 1 to configu re the Add App leT alk Interfac e W eb page para mete rs: T ab le 19-1. Add A ppleT alk Int[...]
-
Page 550
19-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 19 5. Click Apply to a dd the new Appl eT a lk in terf ace, or C ANCEL to resto re previou s settings. Once you click Apply , you are returned to th e AppleT alk I nterfaces W eb page ( Figure 19-4 ) Figure 19- 4. AppleT alk I nterfaces Netw o rk R ang e Sta rt En[...]
-
Page 551
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-7 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng CLI Commands Use the foll owin g C LI co mma nd s in interf ace mo de t o crea te a n A ppl eT a lk inte rfac e: ■ (config-if: <interface-name> )# ap pletalk cable -range <cable -range> ■ (config-if: <interface-name> )# ap pletalk addre ss <network[...]
-
Page 552
19-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 19 3. T o add a new zone, en ter the new AppleT alk zone name i n the Add text field and click Add. Repeat this st ep as needed f or each ne w zone on this in ter fa ce. 4. T o change a zone na m e(s), place a check mark(s) in the Select co lumn and mak e the chan[...]
-
Page 553
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-9 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng CLI Command T o edit an Appl eT alk interfac e using the CLI , e nte r the foll owi ng command from Int erface m ode: (config-if: <interface-name> )# appletalk <options> Deleting an A ppleT alk Interface Y ou can delete an AppleT alk inter face using eith er th[...]
-
Page 554
19-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 Creating an App leT alk St atic Rou te Y ou can creat e an AppleT alk stat ic route using t he W eb Agent or t he CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o creat e an AppleT alk static route us ing the W eb Agent : 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Routing >[...]
-
Page 555
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-11 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng 4. Clic k APPL Y to add t he static r oute, or CANCEL t o rest ore pr evi ous setting s. When you click APPL Y , you are returne d to the AppleT alk Sta tic Route W eb page. S ee Figure 19-8 . Figure 19-8. AppleT alk S tatic Ro ute W eb Page. T able 19-2. Add AppleT alk S[...]
-
Page 556
19-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 CLI Command T o create a n AppleT alk stat ic route using the CLI, enter the foll owing command i n Interface mode: (config-if: <interface-name> )# app letalk static cable-range <cable -range> to <network.node> [floa t ing] zone <zone-name&[...]
-
Page 557
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-13 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng 3. If y ou need to add a new z one, enter the new Ap pleT alk zone name and click Add in the Add text field. If you need to delete a zone(s), place a chec k in th e Select column n ext to the zone yo u need to delete then click t he DELETE button. 4. Nav igate bac k the A[...]
-
Page 558
19-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 Figure 19- 1 1. AppleT alk S tatic Rout e 2. Select the App l eT alk static rout e that you want to delete from the Select colum n. 3. Click DELETE to remove t he AppleT alk static r oute. CLI Command T o delete a n AppleT alk static route using the CLI, ent er[...]
-
Page 559
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-15 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Web A g e n t Procedure T o crea te a n N BP F ilt er usin g th e W eb A ge nt: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > Apple T alk > Configurat ion folders, and then click NBP Filter . The AppleT alk N BP Filter W eb page is di splayed i n the content pa[...]
-
Page 560
19-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 CLI Command T o c rea te an N B P fi lter us ing the C LI, e nte r the fo llo wing comm an d from Interf ace mode: (config-if: <interface-name> )# app letalk acces s-list <a ccess- list -numb er> {permit | deny} nbp <string> Editing an Ap pleT[...]
-
Page 561
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-17 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng 3. Clic k: — CREA TE to add a ne w filter . The Add AppleT alk NBP Fi lter W eb pa ge is disp layed. See “ Creat ing an Apple T alk Name- Binding P rotocol (NBP) Filter ” earl ier i n this cha pte r fo r m o re infor matio n. — DELETE to rem ove the s ele cted N B[...]
-
Page 562
19-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 Figure 19- 15. Add/Delete Int erface to NBP Filte r W eb Page 3. Se lec t th e in te rfa ce to b e ad d ed fr o m the Add field pull - down menu. Or Click an interface from th e Select colum n f or th e inte rfa ce tha t y ou want to b e remove. 4. Click: — A[...]
-
Page 563
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-19 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Creating an AppleT alk Zone Filter Y ou can create an Apple T alk Zone F ilter us ing eithe r the W eb Agent or t he CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o create an AppleT alk zone filt er using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > Apple T alk [...]
-
Page 564
19-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 CLI Command T o c rea te an A p ple T al k zon e filte r us ing th e C L I, use the foll o wing command: (configure)# applet alk access-lis t <access-li st-number> {permit | deny} zone <string> Editing an Ap pleT alk Zone F ilter Y ou can edit an Ap[...]
-
Page 565
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-21 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng — CANCEL to rest ore previous set t ings. — Edit If to add or d ele te thi s zo ne filte r to /from an int erfac e. The Add/ Dele te In terf ace to Zo ne Fil ter W eb pa ge i s d isp lay ed . Se e “ Addin g o r Dele ting Int e rfac es to a Zon e Filt er ” la ter i[...]
-
Page 566
19-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 4. Click: — Add to add thi s z one f ilte r to th e sel ecte d inte rfa ce. — DELETE to rem ov e thi s zo ne filte r fr om th e s elec ted int erf ace. — CANCEL to re sto re pr evi o us se ttin gs . CLI Commands T o add interf aces to a z one filter usi n[...]
-
Page 567
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-23 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Viewing AppleT alk Glo bal St atistics Y ou can view Appl eT alk glo bal statisti cs using eithe r the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view Apple T alk glob al statisti cs using t he W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > Appl[...]
-
Page 568
19-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 2. See T able 19-5 for i nformation ab out the Appl eT alk Global S tatistics W eb pa ge parameters . 3. C lick REFRESH to updat e all stati stics, or CLEAR to re set al l statis tics to zer o. T able 19-5. Apple T alk Global S tatis tical W eb Page Par ameters[...]
-
Page 569
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-25 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng CLI Command T o vi ew A ppl eT al k glo bal s tati stic s usin g th e CL I, ent er th e foll owin g command from Privi leged mode: # show apple talk traffic Viewing the AppleT alk Interface St atistics T able Y ou can view the AppleT alk interfa ce stati stics table usin [...]
-
Page 570
19-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 Figure 19- 20. AppleT alk Interface S tati stics T able 2. See T able 19-6 fo r inform ation on the Ap pl eT a lk Int erf ace S tat isti cs Ta b l e parameters: CLI Command T o view the App leT alk Interf ace stat istics table using the CLI, enter the followi n[...]
-
Page 571
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-27 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Web A g e n t Procedure T o view the Apple T alk r oute tabl e, and de lete o r flus h entr ies fr om the ta ble using the W eb Age nt: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > AppleT alk > Display folders , and then cli c k Route T able . The AppleT alk R[...]
-
Page 572
19-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 CLI Command T o view the App leT alk Interf ace stat istics table using the CLI, enter the followi ng command: > show applet alk r oute V iewing AppleT alk Ro ute T ab le S tatistics Y ou can view Appl eT alk route tabl e stat isti cs usi ng ei ther t he W e[...]
-
Page 573
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-29 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng 2. Se e Ta b l e 1 9 - 8 for informa tion o n AppleT alk Route T able S tat isti cs W eb page para meters: CLI Command Currently th ere is no CLI comma nd to show app leT alk Route S tatistics . Viewing the AppleT alk A RP Cache T able Y ou can view th e AppleT alk ARP ca[...]
-
Page 574
19-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 2. See T able 19-9 for a definition of the AppleT alk ARP Cache T able para meters. 3. Se lec t th e A R P ent ries tha t y ou wa nt to d ele te and clic k Delete Entri e s . or Click Fl ush Route T able to res et the A R P c a che tab le entr ies . O n ly Dyna[...]
-
Page 575
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-31 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Viewing the AppleT alk Z one T able Y ou can view the AppleT alk Zone table using eit her the W eb Agent or t he CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view th e App leT al k z one tab le u sin g the W eb A ge n t: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > AppleT al[...]
-
Page 576
19-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19 V iewing AppleT alk Zone T able St atistics Y ou can view th e AppleT alk Zone T able S tatistic s using either t he W eb Agent or t he CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o view AppleT alk zone tabl e stati stics us ing th e W eb Agent : 1. In the naviga tion pa[...]
-
Page 577
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 19-33 Config uring AppleTa lk Routi ng Viewing the AppleT alk N BP T able Y ou can view the AppleT alk NBP T able using either the W eb Agent or t he CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view the Appl eT alk NBP ta ble using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > AppleT alk > Disp[...]
-
Page 578
19-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 19[...]
-
Page 579
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 20-1 20 Managing Intelligent Multicasting Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 2 and layer 3 modu le configurati ons: ■ Introdu ction ■ Conf iguri ng I ntell ige nt Mult icas tin g ■ Managing I G MP Snooping ■[...]
-
Page 580
20-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Rout er p o rts a re po r ts th at a re at tache d to (or i n the p a th to ) mul tica st route rs an d mu st be trea ted s pe cia lly . Al l m ult ic ast tr affic on a VLA N mu st be forwar ded to the ro uter port. Configur ation of an I ntellig ent Multic ast[...]
-
Page 581
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-3 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting The Learning Process, I GMP Snooping T o learn whic h sessions must be configured, or whi ch client or ro uter port s must be added or removed, a mech anism to draw that in formation fr om the layer 3 pr otocols must be en abled. For the A vaya M ultiservic e Switch, IG[...]
-
Page 582
20-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 20 The Dissemination Process, LGMP and CGMP Snooping The Dissemi nation Process p rovides a meth od to dynamic ally configu re mult ica st sess ion s on s wit ch es w i th V L ANs that do no t ha ve IP i nte rfac es. See Figur e 20-1 . Figure 20- 1. LGMP and CGMP [...]
-
Page 583
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-5 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Configuring I ntelligen t Mult icasti ng This sect ion provides t he following pro cedures: ■ Conf iguri ng G l oba l In te llig ent Mu ltic ast ing ■ Displayi ng Router Po rts ■ Configur ing Static Router Ports ■ Sear ching for Intell ige nt Mult ica st Se ssio[...]
-
Page 584
20-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Figure 20- 2. Intelligent M ulticasti ng Global Configurat ion W eb Page *Note: In orde r to ro ute multi cas t traffic , IP multi cas t for ward ing must be e nabled on t he switch. See “ Enabling IP Rout ing Global Para mete rs ” in Chapte r 12 , “ Co n[...]
-
Page 585
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-7 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o configure int elligent mult icasting global ly using the CLI, e nter the following command from Configur e mode: (configure)# set inte lligen t-m ulti cast {e na b le} T ab le 20-1. In telligent Globa l Multicast Configurat ion W eb Page Paramete rs Para[...]
-
Page 586
20-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Displaying Rou ter Port s Y ou can displ ay router ports using eit her the W eb Agen t or the CLI . We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o display router ports us ing the W eb Agent : 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the L2 Switching > I ntellige nt Multic ast fo[...]
-
Page 587
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-9 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o display rout er ports using t he CLI, enter the f ollowing command fr om User mode: > show in tell igen t-mu ltic a st route r -p or t Configurin g St atic Router Port s Y ou can configu r e Static Router ports usi ng either the W eb Agent or the CLI.[...]
-
Page 588
20-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 4. Select All from the VLAN column to add thi s router port to a ll VLANs Or Select a specific VL AN from the VLAN field pull-down m enu. *Note: When adding a r outer port to all VLANs, th e router po rt is added only t o the VLANs bound to th e switch port. T [...]
-
Page 589
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-11 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Figure 20-4. Intelligent Mult icast Se ssion Search W eb Page 2. See Ta b l e 2 0 - 3 fo r a n ex plan atio n of th e In tellig ent Multic ast Sessi on Search W eb page parameters. T ab le 20-3. In telligent Multicas t Session Search W eb Page Parameters Searc h By Par[...]
-
Page 590
20-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 3. Select SEARCH to be gin th e se arc h for th e mu ltic ast s essio n. The Multi cast Sessions W eb page is di splayed.wi th the search re sults. See Figur e 20-5 . Figure 20- 5. Multicast Sessions W eb Page 4. See T able 20-4 for a n explanatio n of the Mult[...]
-
Page 591
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-13 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command To perform a ses s ion search usi ng the CLI, enter t he following command from User mode : > show in tell igen t-mu ltic ast se ssi on <options> Deleting an I ntelligen t Multicast Session Y ou can delete an intelligen t multicast ses sion using e[...]
-
Page 592
20-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Deleting a Multic ast Session C lient Port Y ou can dele te an intel ligent mul ticast session cl ient port by using eit her the W eb Agent or the CLI . We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o delet e a multic ast sessio n client port by using th e W eb Agent: 1. In the[...]
-
Page 593
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-15 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o de le te a mult icas t se ssio n clie nt p o rt us ing th e CLI , en ter th e fo llow i ng command from Conf igure mode: (configure)# clear in tell igen t-m u ltic ast cl ien t-p or t <sessio n-id> port <mod-port-s pec> Creating a S t atic M[...]
-
Page 594
20-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Figure 20- 7. St atic Multic ast Sessi on W eb Page 2. Select Cr eate to create a new sessi on. The St atic Mul ticast Session Configur ation W eb page is displayed. See Figure 20-8 . Figure 20- 8. St atic Multic ast Session Configurat ion W eb Page 3. Configur[...]
-
Page 595
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-17 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o create a new st atic multicas t session usi ng the CLI, enter the fo llowing command from Conf igure mode: (configure)# set inte llig ent-m ul ti cas t sta t ic-s ess io n <o ptions > Deleting St atic Multicast Sessions Y ou can delete static mult[...]
-
Page 596
20-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 3. Click DELETE to rem ove the st atic multic ast session. CLI Command T o delet e a stat ic multicast session using the CLI, e nter th e follo wing command f rom Configure mode : (configure)# clear i nte llig en t-m ulti cas t sta tic -ses s ion <options>[...]
-
Page 597
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-19 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Figure 20-10 . S tatic Mult icast Sessions Cl ients Port W eb Page 3. Enter the new port number to be added in the Port fi eld , . 4. Clic k Add Client Port . The new por t is added. CLI Command T o create a stati c client port usi ng the CLI, ente r the following comm[...]
-
Page 598
20-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Managin g IGMP Snooping This sec t ion provides t he followi ng procedures for managing Interne t Group Manageme nt Protocol (IGMP) snoo ping: ■ Enabling I GM P Snooping ■ V iewing IGMP Snooping S tatistic s Enabling I GMP Snooping Y ou can enable IGMP snoo[...]
-
Page 599
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-21 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting 2. Sele ct Enab le fr om the S tate field. 3. Clic k APPL Y to comp lete the operation or CANCEL to ignore the operati on. CLI Command T o enable IGMP Snoo ping using the CLI, enter the foll owing command from Configu re mode: (configure)# set igm p-sn oopin g e nabl e[...]
-
Page 600
20-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 3. Click: — CLEAR to clear the statis tics. — REFRESH to refre sh the contents of the table. CLI Command T o view IGMP snoop ing statisti cs, use the following CLI command: > show igmp-snoopi ng statistics Managin g the LGMP Server This sec t ion provide[...]
-
Page 601
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-23 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Figure 20-12 . LGMP Server Configurat ion W eb Page 2. See Ta b l e 2 0 - 9 to configure the LGMP Server Conf igurati on W eb page para mete rs. 3. Clic k... — APPL Y to save your c hanges. — CANCEL to rest ore previous set t ings.[...]
-
Page 602
20-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 T able 20-9. LGMP Serve r Configuration W eb Page Par ameters Parameter De finitio n Enable St ate Select to enable or di sable LGMP server configurati on. The default value is Disabled. Proxy Mo de Select to en able or di sable Prox y mode. Proxy mode allows t[...]
-
Page 603
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-25 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o configure the LGMP server usi ng the CLI, enter the following command from Configu re mode: (configure)# set lgm p se rve r <optio ns> Viewing the LGMP Server S tatistics Y ou can view the LGM P server statis tics using eit her the W eb Agent or t[...]
-
Page 604
20-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 CLI Command T o v ie w LG MP ser ver stat is tic s, use th e fo llow ing C LI com ma nd: > show lg m p s erv e r sta tis tics V iewing the LGMP Server St atistics p er VLAN Y o u ca n vie w the LGM P ser ver stat isti cs p er VL A N usi ng e ith er th e W eb[...]
-
Page 605
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-27 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting CLI Command T o view the LGMP ser ver statisti cs per VLAN, use the f ollowing CLI command: > show lgmp server statistics vlan {all | <vlan-id> | name <vlan-name> } T able 20-10. LGMP Server Display p er VLAN W eb Page Parameters Parameter Defini tion Se[...]
-
Page 606
20-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Manag ing the LGM P Cl ient This sec t ion provides t he followi ng procedures for managing t he Lucent Group Manageme nt Protocol (LGMP) clie nt: ■ Enabling t he LGMP Client ■ V iewing L GMP Cl ien ts Statistics ■ V iewi ng LG MP Cl ie nts per V LAN st a[...]
-
Page 607
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-29 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting T able 20-1 1. LGMP Client Confi guration W eb Pag e Parameters Parameter Defini tion Enable State Select t o enable or disable LGMP client. The default value is Disabled. LGMP Clie nts Displays th e number of LGM P clients per V LAN and opens the LGMP Client Displays [...]
-
Page 608
20-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 Enabling the L GMP C lient Y ou can enab le the LGMP c lient stat istics using eit her the W eb Agent or the CLI. We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o enabl e an LGMP cli ent usin g the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the L2 Switching > I ntellige [...]
-
Page 609
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-31 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Viewing LGMP Client s per VLAN st ati stics Y ou can view LGMP client s per VLAN statistics using ei ther the W eb Agent or th e CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view LGMP client statistics per VLAN using the W eb Agent : 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the L2 Swi[...]
-
Page 610
20-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 CLI Command T o view LGMP cl ient sta tistics pe r VLAN, use the follo wing CLI command: > show lgmp cli ent st atis tic s vlan {all | <vlan-i d> | name <vlan-name> } Managin g CGMP Snooping Y ou can manage Ci sco Group Ma nagement Proto col (CGM[...]
-
Page 611
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-33 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Figure 20-16 . CGM P Snooping W eb Page Enabl ing CGMP Sn ooping Y ou can enable CGMP Sno oping usin g either the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o enable CGMP snoopi ng using the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the L2 Swit chi ng >[...]
-
Page 612
20-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20 CLI Command T o enable CGMP sno oping using th e CLI, enter the following co m mand from Configur e mode: (configure)# set c gmp enable T able 20-13. CGMP Snoopi ng W eb Page Parameters Parameter De finitio n Enable St ate Select to enable or disable CGMP snoop[...]
-
Page 613
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 20-35 Managin g Intelligent M ulticasting Viewing CGMP Snooping Y ou can view CGMP Snoopi ng using ei ther the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view CGMP snooping using the W eb Age nt: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the L2 Swit chi ng > In te llig e nt Mult icast fo lder s , an d t [...]
-
Page 614
20-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 20[...]
-
Page 615
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 21-1 21 Monitoring the A vaya Multiservice Switch Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 2 and layer 3 modu le configurati ons: ■ Interp reting Front Pane l LED Displays ■ Checking Ac tive Alarms ■ Using the Event[...]
-
Page 616
21-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 21 Checking Active Alarms Each switch stores a table of active alarms from whic h you can view a list of open iss ues without havin g to view the en tire event log . This provides you with a qui ck snapshot of t he switch’ s health. Y ou can view th e active ala[...]
-
Page 617
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-3 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Figure 21-1. Active Alarm T able W eb Page CLI Command Use the show al arms CLI command to view the act ive alar m table. Y ou can ente r th is co m man d in U ser m ode . Using the Event Subsystem Overview The A vaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice sw itches ha ve[...]
-
Page 618
21-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 21 This secti ons cont ai ns proc edures for the follo wing ta sks: ■ Configuri ng Event Notifica tion ■ Configuri ng Notification of Protocol Events ■ Setting Lo g Size ■ V iewing the Event and Shutdown Logs ■ Clearing t he Event Log ■ V iewing Event [...]
-
Page 619
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-5 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Figure 21-2. General Event Management W eb Page 2. In the ID field, sele ct the classes of events that you want logged. T able 21-2 lis ts the classes of events that you can log and wh at events are logge d for each class . If you ena ble event notif ication for[...]
-
Page 620
21-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 21 4. Click APPL Y . T able 21-2. Event Classes Class Determine s whether the switch se nds a not ific at ion fo r ... St a r t Starts of th e s ystem. System System events. Configuratio n Each configuration change (for ex ample, enabling and disablin g ports ). T[...]
-
Page 621
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-7 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch CLI Command Use the follo wing CLI commands to configure eve nt notificati on: ■ T o log event s in the event log a nd in the shutdown l og, (configure)# logging histor y {start | syste m | c onf ig | t emp | re source | fan | power | service_ port | user_port[...]
-
Page 622
21-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 21 ■ T o forwa rd e ven ts to s ysl og s erv er s, (configure)# set sysl og faci li ty {sta rt | sys te m | config | temp | resource | fan | service_p ort | user_port | power | br idge_stat | swi tch_fabri c | ospf | rip | ldap | appl etalk | auth_failur e | red[...]
-
Page 623
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-9 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Figure 21-3. Protocol Event Manage m ent W eb Page 2. Enabl e the categorie s of protocol ev ents for which you want to genera te notific ations. See T able 21-3 for an explanation of each cat egory . 3. Clic k APPL Y . T ab le 21-3. Pr otocol Event Categories E[...]
-
Page 624
21-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 CLI Command T o set whi ch catego ries of protoc ol events gene rate notific ations, use the followi ng CLI command: (configure)# loggi ng protocol e vent {rip | ospf | dv m rp | ldap | cli | snmp | appletalk | vrrp} {f ault | e rror | warning | in fo | tra ce [...]
-
Page 625
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-11 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Viewing the Event an d Shut down Lo gs Y ou can view the event l og and shutdown lo g using eithe r the W eb Agent or the CLI. Web A g e n t Procedure T o view the event log or shutdown log using the W eb Agen t: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Events [...]
-
Page 626
21-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 4. Click Sear ch . The event log or shutdown lo g is displayed i n the content pan e. See Figure 2 1-5 . For an explanation o f the event log f i elds, see T able 2 1-4 . * Note: If you do n ot s e lect a sev e rity lev el or e vent t ype , the e nti re event l[...]
-
Page 627
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-13 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Clearing the Event Log Y ou must have re ad-wri te acce ss to clea r the eve nt log. Th is func ti onali ty is not avail able if you have read-only acc ess. Web A g e n t Procedure T o clea r th e e ven t lo g: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Events fo[...]
-
Page 628
21-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 Configuring Sysl og Event Report ing Overview The A vay a Mul tise rvi ce s witch es s upp o rts s ysl og ev ent repo rtin g . Th is featu re m a kes it po s sib le to fo rw ar d sp ecif ic s ys tem e ven ts to r emo t e devices to be logged. Y ou se lect the c[...]
-
Page 629
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-15 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Y ou can specif y a maximum of t hree remote sysl og servers . Syslog messages from the A vaya Multiser vice switch are unidirectiona l. No acknowledge m ent is expect ed from the syslog server . * Note: If you enable syslog eve nt reporting, A vaya recommen ds[...]
-
Page 630
21-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 3. In the Enable S tate field , sele ct Enable or Dis able : ■ Enable —Enabl es syslog repor ting to the IP address es that you enter in the Syslog Coll ector’s I P Addresses fi elds. ■ Disable —Disables syslo g reporti ng. Syslog is dis abled by de f[...]
-
Page 631
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-17 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Configuring Ut ilization Monitoring Overview Utilizat ion monitoring mak es it possible for you to monit or util ization of the: ■ CPU—the numbe r of packet s per second tha t the CPU on the supervi sor module routes (slow path ). ■ Forwardi ng engine—t[...]
-
Page 632
21-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 To disable util izat ion monit oring , enter Global Con figur ation mode and use the fol lowing command: clear ut ilization monito ring {cpu | forwardi ng-engine} Enabling Eve nt Loggin g of Uti lization To en able event logging of utilization, enter Global Con[...]
-
Page 633
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-19 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Setting a Ut ilization Th reshold T o set a uti lization thre shold, enter Globa l Configurat ion mode and u se the follow ing command : set utiliz ation high-thre sho ld {c pu | FIRE | F O RE} <utili zatio n-pe rce nt> The defaul t setting for the utiliz[...]
-
Page 634
21-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 V iewing Utilization Settings T o view the c urrent utili zation sett ings, use t he following command: show util ization settin gs Y ou can enter this command from user mode. A sample of the display is as follows : CPU monitoring is disabled Forwarding Engine [...]
-
Page 635
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 21-21 Monitorin g the Avaya Mul tiservic e Switch Sample 8: 3 percent Sample 9: 3 percent Sample 10: 2 percent Sample 11: 3 percent Viewing S t atistics fo r Forwarding Engin e Utilization T o display the st atistics fo r for war din g engine ut il iz ation, use the fol lowi ng command: sho w uti liza tio n re[...]
-
Page 636
21-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 21 The command dis plays a history o f utilizat ion and th e averag e utiliz ation. A sample of the display is as follows: Average statistics over the 120 second sample window: Forwarding Engine Utilization =1 percent. Forwarding Engine Total Packet Rate = 28843 P[...]
-
Page 637
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 22-1 22 Monitoring and Configuring the Forward ing Cache Ove rview Contents The inf ormation and proce dures provided in this chapter pertai n to laye r 3 module co nfigurat ion only: ■ Conf igu rin g th e F orw ar di ng C ac he ■ Monito ring the Forwardi ng Cache Stat isti[...]
-
Page 638
22-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 22 T o prevent t his issue fro m occurr ing, monitor the f orwarding cache a nd increas e the maximum number of system entries a s necessary . Y ou may need to a djust the se tting in itially t o accommodat e peaks in networ k demand. Configuring the For warding C[...]
-
Page 639
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 22-3 Monito ring and Config uring the F orwarding Cache 3. Clic k: — APPL Y to save your c hanges — CANCEL to rest ore previous set t ings — REFRESH to updat e your system co nfigurat ion — CLEAR to res et al l co nf igu rat io n pa ra me te rs to zer o . T ab le 22-1. Lay er-3 Forward ing Cache Config[...]
-
Page 640
22-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 22 CLI Command T o con fig u re th e forw ar din g c ach e usin g the CL I, ent er the foll ow in g commands fr om Configu re mode: ■ (configure)# ip multicast r o ute- ca che <options> ■ (configure)# ip u nic ast rout e-ca ch e <options > ■ (con[...]
-
Page 641
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 22-5 Monito ring and Config uring the F orwarding Cache Figure 22-2. Frame Forwarding S tatist ics W eb P age 2. See Ta b l e 2 2 - 2 fo r an ex pla nat io n fo r the F ram e Fo rw ard ing Stat isti cs W eb page par ameters. T ab le 22-2. Fra m e Forwardi ng S tat istics W eb Page Para m eters Parameter Define[...]
-
Page 642
22-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 22 Displaying and Searching th e L3 Forwarding Ca che for an Entry We b A g e n t Proc edu re Y ou can di splay and s earch the Layer 3 Forwarding Cache for an en try using th e W eb Agent, T o displ ay the conten ts of the L3 forwarding Cache , you can us e the s[...]
-
Page 643
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 22-7 Monito ring and Config uring the F orwarding Cache T o search the L3 address cache using the W eb Age nt: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Routing > L3 For warding Cache folders , and then cli c k Entry Search . The Active Forwarding Cache Ent r y Search W eb pa ge is dis played in the conte nt[...]
-
Page 644
22-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 22 T able 22-3. L3 For warding Cache Ent ry Search W eb Page Paramet ers Parameter Al lows you to s earc h for all entrie s... Destination Address W ithin the routing cache that match the specified desti nation addr ess (IP addr ess), or IPX netwo rk number Source[...]
-
Page 645
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 22-9 Monito ring and Config uring the F orwarding Cache Figure 22-4. Forwarding Cache Searc h by VLAN CLI Command T o display the L3 Forwarding Cache ca che, use one of the following commands for a specific rout ing ca che: ■ > show ip un i cas t cac h e ■ > show ip mu lticast cache ■ > show ipx[...]
-
Page 646
22-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 22 Figure 22- 5. Active FE Ca che W eb Page 2. T o modify your FE Cache table, do one of the following : — Sele ct th e entr y an d clic k Flush Entry to dele te one or mo re entri es — Click Flush T able to cl ear t he e ntir e ta ble * Note: Fl ushing the ta[...]
-
Page 647
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 22-11 Monito ring and Config uring the F orwarding Cache T able 22-4. Active FE Cache W eb Page Fields Parameter Defines... Fabric/ Chip Ind ex The Pack et Routing Engin e in question. T ype The type of packet (f or example, IP unicast, IP multicast). Mode The table mode w hich incl udes: • DA-Only • SA &a[...]
-
Page 648
22-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 22[...]
-
Page 649
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 23-1 23 Using RMON and Ethernet S t atistics to Analyze Network Performance Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 2 and layer 3 modu le configurati ons: ■ V iewing Network S tatistics ■ Setting Up Port Mirr oring F[...]
-
Page 650
23-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 23 Figure 23- 1. Module S tatistics W eb pa ge 2. Select Clear C ount ers to ge t a fr esh vie w of th e st at isti cs b ein g gather ed. This reset s all of the counters to zero, so that yo u can track the counter s from a speci fic point forward. 3. Select a mod[...]
-
Page 651
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-3 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance 4. Click Cle ar Counters t o get a fr esh view of the st atisti cs being ga thered. This rese ts all of the c ounters to zero so tha t you can t r ack the counter s from a par t icular point for ward. 5. Sele ct a port from the Name colu[...]
-
Page 652
23-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 23 T able 23 -1 . Et her n et In ter fac e S t at isti cs W eb P age Fie lds S tat isti c Indic ates Actio ns Sample The sample nu mber . N/A Interval Start The date and time this log entry was made. N/A Utilization Percentage of utilization. The percentage of ava[...]
-
Page 653
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-5 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance Multicasts Normal during network operation. For example, multicast packets are to sen d target video s treams to selected stations on the netw ork, an d are part of the operation of th e S panning T ree Protocol . Possible causes : • T[...]
-
Page 654
23-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 23 Oversized Packets Count of packets with a valid CRC t hat violate the maximum Ethernet packet size. These malforme d packets are most often the result of software errors. Possible cause: Device or application creating non-co mpliant packets. Possible action: Us[...]
-
Page 655
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-7 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance CLI Command T o vi ew ne twor k sta tis tics usi ng the CLI, ent e r the foll o win g com m an d in Priv ile ged m ode : (configure)# show ethernet counter s <cr | mod-num | mod-swport- spec> Setting Up Port Mirroring Configuri ng [...]
-
Page 656
23-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 23 Packets addressed to the CPU, such as pings, ar e duplicated out of the mirror por t. T agged packets th at are sent int o a source port with a VLAN ID to which t he source port i s not b ound, are no t transmitted o ut the mir ror port. VLAN ta g information i[...]
-
Page 657
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-9 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance Web A g e n t Procedure T o set up a por t mirror on a swit ch in Fabr ic mode 1 by usin g the W eb Agent: 1. In t he navigation pan e , expand the Modules & Ports folder , and then click Port Mirror ing . The Port Mir roring Informa[...]
-
Page 658
23-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 23 3. Select a sour ce port for tr affic fr om the Configur e Source c olumn. The Port Mir roring Configura tion W eb page is di splayed. See Figur e 23-5 . Figure 23- 5. Port Mirroring Conf iguration W eb pag e 4. See T able 23-3 for a n explanatio n of the field[...]
-
Page 659
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-11 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance Piggyback P ort Por t used to enable bi -directional port mi rroring. If no pi ggyback port is speci fied, on ly received traf fic from the source port will go t o the mirror port. The piggyback port should have the same bandw idth as t[...]
-
Page 660
23-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 23 CLI Command T o s et up a n R MON m irr or p or t by usin g the CLI, ent e r the foll o win g command f rom Enable/Conf igure mode: (configure)# set po rt mirror <mod-port-r ange> Setting Up Port Mirro ring on a Switch in Fabri c Mode 2 Fabric mod e 2 por[...]
-
Page 661
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-13 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance Web A g e n t Procedure T o use the W eb Agent to set up port mirroring on a switch in Fa bric mode 2: 1. Exp and the Modules & Ports folde r . 2. Clic k P o rt M i rrorin g . The Port Mir roring Informat ion W eb page is displayed [...]
-
Page 662
23-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 23 T able 23-4. Port Ranges for Fa bric Mode 2 Port Mirrorin g Module Port ranges that you can mirr or 4-por t gigabi t modul es • 1–2 • 3–4 • Any s ingle port Y ou can mirror any fo ur single port s simultaneo usly (one port per channel). However yo u c[...]
-
Page 663
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-15 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance 3. Se lect t he Chann el and t he ass ociat ed p ort fr om the Sou r ce Po rt column pull-down m enu. 4. In th e Mi rror P ort column pull- down menu, select the port to which you wan t to mi rr or tr affic. Both the s ource port and mi[...]
-
Page 664
23-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 23 7. Do one of the fo llowing: 8. If you selec ted T r ansm it /DA F i lter in th e Direct ion /Fi lte r field, e nter the MAC a ddress tha t you want to mon itor in t he DA Fil ter field for the port m irr or . 9. If you sel ected Re ceive/ SA Filter in the Dire[...]
-
Page 665
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 23-17 Using R MON and Ethernet Statistics to Ana lyze Network Pe rformance CLI Command Use the following CLI commands to configure Fabr ic mode 2 port mirroring . Y ou must be in Global Config uration command mode t o enter these commands. T o set u p por t mi rror ing, use the fo llow in g CLI comm an d: (con[...]
-
Page 666
23-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 23 Removing a Fa bric Mode 2 Port Mirro r We b A g e n t Proc edu re T o remove a port mirr or on a switch in Fabric mode 2 by usi ng the W eb Agent: 1. In the naviga tion pane, expa nd the Modules & Ports folder, and th en click Port Mirror ing . The Port M i[...]
-
Page 667
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 24-1 24 Managing Buffers and Queues on 50-Series Modules Ove rview The followi ng informa tion and procedur es provided in t his chapter per tain to layer 2 and layer 3 modu le confi gurations. Buf fer management f eatures help you to optimize traf fic through put through th e [...]
-
Page 668
24-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 24 The Servi ce Ratio can be cho sen to match tr aff ic patterns a nd performance require ments using a weigh ted round robin s cheduling algori thm. The avail abl e se rvic e ratio s o f th e al gor it hm are d e fine d in “ Managing Buf fers and Queues ” . T[...]
-
Page 669
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 24-3 Managing Buffers and Q ueues on 50-Series Mo dules Figure 24-1. M odule Informati o n W eb Page 2. Sele ct the module who se buf fers you want to m anage f r om the Select column. 3. S ele ct th e Module number f or tha t mo dul e f rom t he Buf fer Manage ment column. The Buf f er Manage ment W eb page i[...]
-
Page 670
24-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 24 5. Select the Fa bri c P o rt Buf fer number whos e a sso ci ate d buffe rs you wa nt to manage . The Buffer De tail Configuratio n W eb page for t hat fabric port is dis pla yed. See Figure 24-3 . T able 24-1. Buf fer Management W eb Page Parameters Parameter [...]
-
Page 671
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 24-5 Managing Buffers and Q ueues on 50-Series Mo dules Figure 24-3. Buffer Det ail Conf iguration W eb Page 6. See Ta b l e 2 4 - 2 for an explana tion of the Buf fer Detail Configur ation W eb page input and outp u t fi el ds: T ab le 24-2. Buf fer Det ail Config uration W eb Page Paramete rs Parameter Defi [...]
-
Page 672
24-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 24 High Priority Allocation Displays the percent of the buf fer ’ s queuing space allotted to high priority traf fic. Because the high -priority queue is serviced more frequently th an the normal priority queue, raising this value may not necessarily provide bet[...]
-
Page 673
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 24-7 Managing Buffers and Q ueues on 50-Series Mo dules 7. Repea t Steps 1- 4 to tune P hy si cal P or t (F as t Ethe rne t) bu ffers . Ph ysic al Port port s have addition al buffers on both the input and output ports . 8. Clic k APPL Y to save your change s, or CANCEL to re sto re prev iou s setting s. CLI C[...]
-
Page 674
24-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 24[...]
-
Page 675
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6. 1 25-1 25 80-Series QoS Ove rview Quality of Service (QoS) is a set of tools that make it poss ible for you to manage traf fic acro ss a switch or a ne twork. These to ols prote ct specific traf fic from the ef fects of ne twork congestio n. Y ou can enabl e these featur es for a[...]
-
Page 676
25-2 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Why implemen t QoS? Purpose of QoS In a ne tw ork t h at ha s ti me-s ens itiv e tra ffic (V oIP ) or ba nd width -in ten siv e traf fic (real-t ime or near -real-t im e st rea ming -video), QoS makes it possi bl e for you t o prioriti ze the ti me-sensitive t [...]
-
Page 677
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-3 80-Serie s QoS How Does QoS W ork? The QoS process st arts at the poi nt where a frame ent ers the switch and ends when the fr ame exits the swit ch. This sectio n describes the Q oS proce ss from star t to finish: ■ QoS Process for Ingress T raffic ■ QoS Process for Egress T raffic ■ Diagram of QoS[...]
-
Page 678
25-4 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 25 3. Forwarding the fr ame or packet from the ingress queue to its destinati on. If you enable poli cing for the que ue, the switch forwards ingress traf fic that f alls wit hin the maxi mum bit rate that you set an d drops ingress traf fic that e xceeds the maxi[...]
-
Page 679
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-5 80-Serie s QoS Example Y ou want to a ssign a pr iority of 5 to a V oIP flow that is destined to a n IP 600 phone swi tch. Y ou then want t h e switch to use t he CBWFQ queue- servici ng algorit hm to forwa r d frames from queue 5. The IP 600 phone switch is connected to an A vaya P88 2 Multiservice s wit[...]
-
Page 680
25-6 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Diagram of QoS Process Figure 25 - 1 illust rate s th e Qo S pr oces s fro m wh en a f ram e ent ers the s witc h to when th e frame exits th e switch. Figure 25- 1. QoS Proces s ÖÖ Frame is forwarded from in gress priority queue to egres s port. NOTE: If pol[...]
-
Page 681
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-7 80-Serie s QoS Class ifica tion of T r af fic The switch a ssigns t raf fic to one of eight queues acc ording to t he prior ity , or “cla ss, ” of th e tra ffic. Pr iori ties ra nge 0 to 7 , 7 bei ng t he h ig he st pr iority . Y ou can set the switch to class ify traf fic by the prio rity assign ed t[...]
-
Page 682
25-8 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservi ce Switche s, v6.1 Chapt er 25 ■ Setting a Physical Port t o Ignore T ag Prio rity ■ Sett ing th e Prio rity o f a MAC Add ress ■ Displayin g the Priori ty of a MAC Address ■ Setting a Physical Port to Use Dif fServ ■ Setting a Physical Port to Mask Dif fServ Bits ■ Ass ignin g a[...]
-
Page 683
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-9 80-Serie s QoS Classifying T raffic b y Layer 2 Characteristics In additi on to Cisco ISL ta g, 802.1p tag, and physical port pr iority , the switch can classify t raf fic by: ■ Source MAC addr ess ■ Destinati on MAC address For informa tion a bout how t o set a prior ity fo r a sour ce or d est inati[...]
-
Page 684
25-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 The prior i ty that is s pecified by an ACL takes prece dence over all ot her priori ties. Because o f th is precedence , th e switch determi nes whet her a rule in an A CL e xis ts for an IP p ack et in th e fi nal stag e of cl ass ific atio n . If an ACL exis[...]
-
Page 685
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-11 80-Serie s QoS Diffserv RFC 2475 defin es a field in t he layer 3 header of IP packe ts, called the Diff Serv code poin t (DSCP). T ypically , hosts or route rs sending tr aff ic into a Dif fServ network ma rk each tr ansmitted pa cket with the app r opriate DSCP . The switc h then uses the DSCP to class[...]
-
Page 686
25-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Supported Nu mber of Queues Ta b l e 2 5 - 3 specifie s the number of ingress and e gress queues that are availab le on each modul e. Layer 2 DSCP (f or bridged IP tra ffic) Destination MAC ad dress priority Source MAC address pr iority 802. 1p tag Cisco IS L t[...]
-
Page 687
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-13 80-Serie s QoS Setting the Priority of a Ph ysical Port CLI Command Use the set port defa ult -pr ior it y command to set the priori ty of a physic al port. Each p hysical port ha s a defaul t priority of 3. The syntax of the command is: (configure)# set port default-prior ity {{ <mod-num> | <mo[...]
-
Page 688
25-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Examp les Setting a Physical Port to Ignore T ag Priorit y CLI Command Use the set p ort ignor e-tag priori ty command to set a p ort to ig nore any layer 2 tag priority ( includin g 802.1p tags). The s yntax of the command i s: (configure)# set po rt ignor e-t[...]
-
Page 689
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-15 80-Serie s QoS Examples T able 25-6. Keywords, Argument s, or Options Keyword, Argument or Op tion Definition <mo d-num> The s lot number of a module. I f you specif y <mod-num> , the switch ignores tag priorities on all por t s of the module. <mod-swp ort-range> The slot n u mber of a [...]
-
Page 690
25-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Setting the Priority of a MAC Address CLI Command Use the set aft entry com mand to set the prio ri ty of a sour ce MAC address or desti n ation MAC address. The s yntax of the command i s: (configure)# set a ft entry <mac-addres s> vlan { <vlan-id>[...]
-
Page 691
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-17 80-Serie s QoS For defini tions of all o t her keywords, ar guments, an d options in thi s command, see Command Refer ence Guide for the A vaya P580 an d P882 Mul tise rvi ce S w itch es, S oft ware V ers io n 6 .1. Examples <ent ry-prio rity> The priority that you want to assign to the destination[...]
-
Page 692
25-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Displaying the Priority of a MAC Address CLI Command Use the show aft e ntry command to dis play the priority of a sour ce MAC address or destination M AC address. The syn tax of the comman d is: > show aft e ntry [mac <wildca rd-mac-a ddress> ] [VLAN [...]
-
Page 693
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-19 80-Serie s QoS Setting a Physical Port to Us e DiffServ CLI Command Use the set por t use-diffserv command to set a port to clas sify bridged IP traf fic by its Dif fServ code point (DSCP). The synt ax for the co mmand is: ( configure)# se t port use- diffserv {{ <mod-num> | <mod-swport- range&g[...]
-
Page 694
25-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Setting a Physical Port to Mask DiffServ Bit s CLI Command Use the set por t m ask-dif fserv command to m ask the three le ast signific ant bits of the DSCP when the swit ch is using the DSCP t o classi fy bridge d IP traffic. If yo u ma sk the thre e le as t s[...]
-
Page 695
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-21 80-Serie s QoS Assigning a Priority to a DSCP CLI Command Use the set dif fse rv pr iori ty com mand to ass ign a prio rity to a D iffSer v code point (DSCP) in the Dif fServ Mapping T abl e. The syntax of the command is : (configure)# set diffs erv p rio r ity <p riority > dscp <dscp-st art- ra[...]
-
Page 696
25-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Displaying the QoS Settin gs for a Physical Port CLI Command Use t he show port command to displ ay the QoS set tings for a physical port. This command d isplays the pri ority of the port , if the port is set to ignore 802.1p tag priority , and if the p ort is [...]
-
Page 697
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-23 80-Serie s QoS The command synt ax is: St andard ACL (configure)# access -list <ac cess-list-name> <access-li st-index> {permit [{use- priority <pr iority> | use-diff ser v [mas k] | remark- dif fserv <ds cp > [mas k] | use-l2}] | deny | fwd1 | f wd2 | fwd3 | fwd4 | fwd5 | fwd6 | [...]
-
Page 698
25-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 <dscp> The DSCP that you want to replace the DSCP of the packet. use-l2 Classifies traf fic by the layer 2 priority of the packet. If you enter use-l2 , the switch ign ores the ACL rule priority and DiffServ priority . deny Blocks t he packet. fwd1 | fwd2[...]
-
Page 699
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-25 80-Serie s QoS * Note: Y ou m ust us e th e CLI to s et up A CLs for Q o S. D o no t atte mpt to u se the IP A cc ess Con tro l W e b p age in t he W eb Age nt to se t up ACLs for QoS. Examples: St andard ACL Rules <dest-ip-a ddr> The destination IP address of the subnet that you want t o assign a [...]
-
Page 700
25-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Examp les : Extended ACL Rules • Replace the existing DSCP with a DSCP of 5 for al l traffic that has a source IP address i n the 10.10.8 0 subne t. • Mask the three least significant bits of the DSCP access-list MyAccessList1 6 permit r emark- d iffserv 5 [...]
-
Page 701
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-27 80-Serie s QoS Assign a priority of 2 to all TCP traf fic that has a: • Source IP address in the 1.1 s ubnet • Source por t that is greater than 24 • Destination IP address in the 6.6 subn et • Destination port of 23 access-list MyAccessList2 3 permit use-pri ority 2 t cp 1.1.0.0 0 .0.255 .255 gt[...]
-
Page 702
25-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Setting Up a Defa ult ACL Rule CLI Command Use the any keyw or d in the access list command to set up a default ACL rule. The r ule wil l be ap plie d to al l pa cke ts on t he s wit ch tha t do no t mat ch any other ACL rules. The comman d syntax is: ( configu[...]
-
Page 703
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-29 80-Serie s QoS Examples Displaying AC L Rules CLI Command Use the show acce ss-lists c omm and to disp lay the ACL rules i n an ACL. The syntax o f this command is: > show acce ss-lists [ <access-lis t-name> ] Ingress Policing Policing makes it possible for y ou to li mit the b andwidth f or in [...]
-
Page 704
25-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 The s wit ch u s e s qu eu e 0 to fo rw ard pro toc ol pa ck et s ( A RP , VRR P , OS PF , and so on) to the supervis or module. If you en able policing on queue 0, be sure to allocate the qu eue enough bandwi dth for management p ackets and learned packets. Fa[...]
-
Page 705
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-31 80-Serie s QoS T able 25-17. Keywords, Argument s, and Options Keyword, Argument or Op tion Definition <mo d-num> The s lot number of a module. I f you specif y <mod-num> , policing is enabled for all ports on the module in the slot that you s pecify . <mod-swp ort-range> The slot n u m[...]
-
Page 706
25-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Displaying the Policing Sett ings Use the show port police command t o di sp lay the settings for polic ing . Fo r inform ation on h ow policing wor ks, see “ Ingre ss Poli ci ng ” earlier in thi s chapter . The s ynt ax for this com mand is: > show port[...]
-
Page 707
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-33 80-Serie s QoS Queue-Servicing Algorithms The followi ng queue-servic ing algorithms a re available f or egress queues : ■ W eighted fair queueing ( W FQ) ■ S tr i ct Pri ority ■ Class-ba sed queuei ng (CBQ) ■ Class-ba sed weight ed fair q ueueing (CBWFQ) * No te : In earlier versions of the swit[...]
-
Page 708
25-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 The s wit ch alw ays s erv ice s the q ueu e th at has the h igh e st accumulated weight . If two q ueue s hav e the same acc umul ate d w eig h t, t he sw it ch fi rst service s the queue that has the highest priority (0 – 7 ). T able 25-19 li sts the defaul[...]
-
Page 709
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-35 80-Serie s QoS St rict Priority Queueing W ith stric t pr i ori ty queuing, the swi tc h s ervices the eig h t queu es i n order of thei r pri ori ty . The h igh est pr i ori ty q ue ue i s se rv ice d unti l it is em pt y , and then the lowe r pri orit y que ues ar e se rvic e d se que n tial ly u nt il[...]
-
Page 710
25-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 ■ The action that you want the switch to tak e when the bi t rate exceeds t he maximum bit rate. — Drop th e packets Or — Forward th e packets acc ording to the weight of the queue * Note: A vaya recommen ds that you do not set a port usi ng CBWFQ as the [...]
-
Page 711
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-37 80-Serie s QoS Setting Up WFQ Use the set port queue servic e wfq command to set a p ort, port range, or module to us e weighted fair queueing (WFQ) queue servicing . WFQ is the default q ueue-servic ing algor ithm. The syntax o f the command is: (configure)# set port queue service {{ <mod-num> | &[...]
-
Page 712
25-38 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Setting Up Strict Priority Queueing CLI Command Use the set p ort queue se rvice strict- priority comm and to set a port, port range, or module to use stric t priority queu e servicing. The s ynt ax o f t he c om m and is : (configure)# set po rt queue service [...]
-
Page 713
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-39 80-Serie s QoS Setting Up CBQ Use the set port queue servic e cbq command to set a p ort, port range, or module to us e class-based qu euing (CBQ) queue ser vicing. The synta x of the comman d is: (configure)# set port queue service {{ <mod-num> | <mod- swport- range> } [..., { <mod-num>[...]
-
Page 714
25-40 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Sett ing Up CBW FQ Use the set po rt queue s ervice cbwfq c ommand to set a port , port range , or module to u se class-based weighted fair qu euing (CBWFQ) queue servici ng. The syntax of the command is: (configure)# set po rt queue service {{ <mod- num>[...]
-
Page 715
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-41 80-Serie s QoS <norma l-burs t> The maximum size o f burs t th at is gu aranteed transfer . Bursts that are smaller than this size are guaranteed transfer . Bursts that are lar ger than this size are either serviced by W FQ or dropped (wh i chever action that y ou specify). The default setting is s[...]
-
Page 716
25-42 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 For info rmation about how CBWFQ works, se e “ CBWFQ ” ea rlie r in this chapter . * Note: The switch doe s not d rop packet s on egre ss queue 7 , even i f you spec ify the dr op keyw or d . This res tric t i on e nsure s th at tr affic management packets [...]
-
Page 717
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-43 80-Serie s QoS Displaying the Queu e-Service Settings CLI Command Use the show port queue service command t o display th e settin gs for queue serv icing. The synt ax for th is command is: > show port queue service { <mod-num> | < mod-swpor t-range> } [..., { <mod-num> | <mod-s wp[...]
-
Page 718
25-44 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 QoS St atis tics Y o u ca n dis p lay QoS s tati stic s fo r: ■ All ports on a module ■ A port or po rt range ■ A specifi c queue on a port, port ra nge, or mo dule T w o set s of st atis tics are disp lay ed f o r egr ess que u es: p ort stat isti cs a n[...]
-
Page 719
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-45 80-Serie s QoS Threshold (% Full) The threshold for q ueue capacity that determines whether additional fr ames are counted tow ard Frames Enqueued Above Thr eshol d or Fr ames E nqueue d Below Thr eshol d . If the number o f frames in the queue exceeds this percentage of the qu eue capacity , the Frames [...]
-
Page 720
25-46 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Egre ss Por t St atistics for 10 / 100 Mod ules The egres s port statis tics for 10/100 m odules a r e reported per 12 ports, not for indi vidual physica l ports. Fo r example, if you di splay the QoS sta tistics for port 20 on a 10/100 mod ule, th e port st at[...]
-
Page 721
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-47 80-Serie s QoS Egress Port St atis tics for Gigabit Modules The egress port statist ics for gigabit modules are repo rted per indi vidual port. T able 25-28 lists the s tat istic s tha t the swi tc h di spl ay s fo r port s on gigabit mod ules. T able 25-27. Egress Port S tatistics for 10/100 Modules S t[...]
-
Page 722
25-48 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Buff er S t atistics for Egress Que ues Y ou can also d isplay the amo unt of memo ry that i s alloca ted to each egre ss queue. The all ocated amount o f memory is dis played in bot h the number of buf fers and the n umber of bytes. Buf fers are 128-byte unit [...]
-
Page 723
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-49 80-Serie s QoS This sect ion contains pro cedures for t he foll owing tasks: ■ Displayi ng QoS S tatis tics ■ Rese ttin g the Q oS Statis tic s ■ Disp lay in g th e B uffer Set tings for E g res s Que ues T ab le 25-29. Buf fer S tat istics for Egre ss Queues S tatistic Expla nation T otal Queue Me[...]
-
Page 724
25-50 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Displaying Qo S S t atis tics Use the show port queue counters to di spl ay QoS statis ti cs . The synt ax of this co m mand is: > show port que ue counters { <mod-num> | <mod-swport-ran ge> } [..., { <mod-num> | <mod-swport -range> }[...]
-
Page 725
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 25-51 80-Serie s QoS Resetting the QoS St atistics Use the r eset port queue counter s to reset t he queue statis tics to 0. The syntax of the command is: > r eset port queue coun ters { <mod-num> | <mod-swport -range> } [ ..., { <mod-num> | <mod-s wport-range> }] {ingress | eg ress [...]
-
Page 726
25-52 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Chapt er 25 Displaying the Buffer Settings for Egress Queu es Use the show port que ue buffer command to di splay the amount of memory that is assi gned to each queue. The s ynt ax o f t he c om m and is : (configure)# show port queue b uff er {{ <mod-num> | <mod-[...]
-
Page 727
User Gui de for the Avaya P 580 and P882 Mul tiservice Switch es, v6.1 A-1 A Upgrading the Application Sof tware CAUTION: Overvi ew Upgradin g the switch s oftware i nvolves the foll owing steps: 1. Backing Up the Cu rrent Software 2. Backing Up the P revious Configura tion 3. Downloading Applicati on Softwar e 4. Se ttin g t he Star tup Im ag e 5.[...]
-
Page 728
Appendi x A A-2 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 CAUTION: Backing Up the Current Sof tware The A vaya Multis ervice swi tches have two memor y locations for storing the em be d ded sw itc h sof twa re: AP P1 a nd A P P2. The se tw o m emo ry locat ion s mak e it pos sib le to s tore th e cu rr ent s oftw a re in[...]
-
Page 729
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 A-3 Upgrading th e Application So ftware Figure A-1. FEPROM Content s W eb page 3. Ensure th at A PP1 conta ins the softw are that y ou wa nt to ba ck up. When you do wnload the n ew application s o ftware, you must down load it to t he APP2 memory location . CLI Command T o de te rm ine th e AP P loc a tion fro m[...]
-
Page 730
Appendi x A A-4 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 2. Select File M anagement . The Confi guration File Mana gement W e b page is di splayed i n the content pane ( Figure A-2 ). Figure A-2. Configuration Fil e Management W e b page 3. In the Save Running-Confi g to S tartup-Confi g fi eld , se le ct Save . 4. In t[...]
-
Page 731
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 A-5 Upgrading th e Application So ftware CAUTION: CLI Command T o back up the cur rent configurat ion to a TF TP server , use the f ollowing command: # copy st artup-config tf tp <filename_opt_path> <tftp-s erve r> Downloadi ng Application Sof tware Y ou can download new a ppl ication softwa re from a [...]
-
Page 732
Appendi x A A-6 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 Figure A-3. System TFTP Update W eb page 3. In the TFTP Server IP Addr ess field , enter the I P address of the TFTP server on which the ne w applicat ion software is stored. 4. In th e File Name field, en t er the na me of the bin ary file t hat yo u wan t to dow[...]
-
Page 733
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 A-7 Upgrading th e Application So ftware Setting the S t artup Image After you d ownload the new s oftware, yo u must set the swit ch to load the new sof t w are at s ta rtup . Y ou ca n us e e ith er th e W eb Ag en t or CLI to perform th is task. Web A g e n t Procedure T o set t he sw it ch to loa d the n e w s[...]
-
Page 734
Appendi x A A-8 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 If any of these settin gs changed during t he synchronizat ion, the stan dby supervi sor module automatic ally resets so that it is failover -ready . In ea rl ie r version s of software, you had to manually re set the standby supervisor , if these se ttings chan g[...]
-
Page 735
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 A-9 Upgrading th e Application So ftware Figure A-4. Sy stem Reset W eb Page 3. Selec t Ye s in respons e to the que stion , Do yo u w ant t o reset the s wit ch? The s wi tc h res ets an d lo ads th e ne w ap plic atio n sof twa re. CLI Command T o re se t th e sw it ch a fter down loa ding new a ppl icat ion so [...]
-
Page 736
Appendi x A A-10 User Gui de for the Avaya P5 80 and P88 2 Multiservice Sw itches, v6.1 CLI Command T o rese t the swit ch after downloa ding new applicat ion software, use the followi ng CLI command: (configure)# rese t V erifying t he Upgrade T o verify t hat the old Acti ve supervisor i s now the S tandby supervi sor , the LED displa y window (m[...]
-
Page 737
User Gui de for the Avaya P 580 and P882 Mul tiservice Switch es, v6.1 B-1 B Boot Mode Boot Mode i s a special mode f or the A vaya P580 and P8 82 Multiservice switch. Boot mode is used to: ■ Recover you r password ■ Download new op erational code This app endix contain s the fol l owing sections: ■ Accessing BOOT M ode ■ Password Rec overy[...]
-
Page 738
Appendi x B B-2 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 Accessing BOOT Mode with Corrupted Operationa l Images The A vaya P580 and P882 Multiservi ce switch will automatica lly come up in BOOT mode if both operationa l image s are corr upted. Y ou will see the following out put on your consol e: Starting the boot syste[...]
-
Page 739
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 B-3 Boot Mode Downloading New Op erational Code T o download new ope rational code in BOOT mode into APP1 or APP2. * Note: The A vay a P580 and P882 Multise rvice switche s do not have an IP addres s assigned to th e console eth ernet por t when it comes up in BOOT mode. The re for e, a user must ass ig n an IP a [...]
-
Page 740
Appendi x B B-4 User Guide f or the Avaya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1[...]
-
Page 741
User Gui de for the Avaya P 580 and P882 Mul tiservice Switch es, v6.1 C-1 C Supported MIB Group s This app endix lists, by p rotocol, public and privat e MIBs that are support ed by the A vaya P58 0 and P882 Multis ervice swi t ches. MIBs are categ oriz ed a s foll ows: ■ AppleT alk ■ Applicat ion Software Management ■ AT M U p l i n k ■ B[...]
-
Page 742
Appendi x C C-2 Us er Guide for the Av aya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 AT M U p l i n k St andard MIB lecmib.mib , MIB for LAN Emulation Cli ent Management, as def ined by the AT M F o r u m . Priv ate MIB avaya1483.mib, MIB for multi-prot ocol over A TM encapsulat ion, as defined in RFC1483. Bridging St andard MIBs ■ rfc1493.mib [...]
-
Page 743
Docu ment No. 10-300 077, Iss ue 2 C-3 Supported M IB Groups IP St andard MIBs ■ rfc2096. m ib, IP Forwardin g T able MIB. ■ rfc2863. m ib, Interf ace MIB. ■ ianaif type.mib, MIB for d ifferent interface types. ■ rfc1213. m ib, MIB II. ■ rfc201 1.mib, SNMPv2 MIB for IP . ■ rfc2012. m ib, SNMPv2 MIB for TCP . ■ rfc2013. mib, SNMPv2 MIB[...]
-
Page 744
Appendi x C C-4 Us er Guide for the Av aya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 Monitorin g St andard MIBs ■ rfc1757.mib , Remote network monito ring MIB. ■ rfc1513.mib , T oken Ring RMON MIB. ■ rfc2856.mib , M IB for HCRMON. ■ draf t-ie tf-r mon mib-h crm on- 10.m ib , I nte rne t Draf t RMO N fo r Hi gh Capacity Ne tworks. ■ rfc2[...]
-
Page 745
User Gui de for the Avaya P 580 and P882 Mul tiservice Switch es, v6.1 D-1 D FCC Notice FCC Notice — Cla ss A Computing Device: This eq uipment generate s, uses, and may em it radio f requency ener gy . The equipment has been type te sted and found to comply with the li mits for a Class A di gital device p ursuant to Part 15 of FCC rules, which a[...]
-
Page 746
Appendi x D D-2 Us er Guide for the Av aya P580 and P882 Multis ervice Swit ches, v6.1 A verti ssement! Cet appar eil est un appareil de Classe A. Dans un environ nement rési dentiel cet appar ei l pe ut provoquer de s br oui ll age s ra dio électriques. Dan s ce cas, il peut êtr e demandé à l' utilisateur d e prendre les mes ures appropr[...]
-
Page 747
User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switche s, v6.1 IN-1 Index Numerics 10/100 por t auto negotiation speed/d uplex advertisement , 8-26 , 8-27 10/100 por t param eter auto-negotiation mode , 8-26 category , 8-26 duplex m ode , 8-26 flow cont rol mode , 8-26 name , 8-2 6 port PACE prior ity , 8-2 7 rate limit burst size , 8-27 ra[...]
-
Page 748
IN-2 Use r Guide for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservice Switches, v6 .1 Inde x delete all l earned entries , 9-1 3 delete invalid learned entries , 9-13 address table ins tance entry type learned , 9-1 2 managem ent , 9-12 multicast , 9-12 self , 9-12 address table ins tance hash table auto increment , 9-12 size , 9-12 address table ins tance p[...]
-
Page 749
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-3 Index RTMP Rq Rx , 19-25 RTMP Rq Tx , 19-2 5 RTMP Rsp Rx , 19-2 5 RTMP Rsp Tx , 19 -25 Short PDU in error , 19-24 too long , 19-24 too short , 19-24 TTL expired , 19-2 4 viewing , 19-23 , 19-25 Zip Ext Reply Rx , 19-25 Zip Ext Reply Tx , 19 -25 Zip GNI Rq Rx , 19- 25 Zip GNI Rq Tx , 19-25 Zip GNI Rsp Rx ,[...]
-
Page 750
IN-4 Use r Guide for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservice Switches, v6 .1 Inde x router por t disp lay parameters , 20-9 area LSA detail , 15-2 7 OSPF interface parameters , 15-10 OSPF summ arie s p ara me ters , 15-17 OSPF virtual lin k pa r a met ers , 15 -14 area ID OSPF area parameters , 15-6 OSPF link parameter s , 15- 21 OSPF lin k state da[...]
-
Page 751
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-5 Index IP global con figuration parameters , 12-12 border Rtrs OSPF statisti cal parameters , 15-20 bridge forw ard delay spanning tree bridge level parameters , 7-12 bridge hello time spanning tree bridge level parameters , 7-12 bridge max age spanning tree bridge level parameters , 7-12 bridge p ort span[...]
-
Page 752
IN-6 Use r Guide for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservice Switches, v6 .1 Inde x VTP snoo ping parameters , 6-31 configure , 20 -9 , 20- 10 configure p orts gigabit module , 8-1 2 , 8-16 , 8-21 , 8-27 configure sou rce port m irroring i nformatio n parameters , 23-9 configure st atic router ports static rou ter ports , 20 -9 , 20-10 configuri n g[...]
-
Page 753
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-7 Index create a Custom Access Type , 2- 13 creating , 12- 19 Creating 3 C om Mapping Tables Usi ng the Web Agent , 6-1 3 creating a BOOTP/DHCP server entry , 12-24 , 12 -25 creating a multinet interface , 12-15 creating a static client port , 20-18 , 20-19 creating a VRRP router , 12-74 creating access rul[...]
-
Page 754
IN-8 Use r Guide for the Av aya P580 and P88 2 Multiservice Switches, v6 .1 Inde x forwarding in terface , 12-66 desi gn ate d po rt spanning tree bridge port paramet ers , 7-16 desi gnat e d ro ot spanning tree bridge port paramet ers , 7-16 destination address Layer 3 rou te cache search par ameters , 22- 8 destination filena me configuration fil[...]
-
Page 755
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-9 Index DVMRP do wnstream dep endent router DVMRP su pported major/mi nor version , 12-67 foun d on inter fa c e , 12 -67 router is SNMP manageable , 12 -67 router ne t work addres s , 12- 67 router received p robe from this router , 12-67 router supp orts generation ID function , 12 -67 router supp orts pr[...]
-
Page 756
IN-10 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x router cost to sour ce network , 12-65 router netw ork address , 12-65 view ing , 12-65 DVMRP upstream sour ce parameters destination group address , 12-71 destination port number , 12- 71 flow source address , 12-71 flow upstream interface , 12-71 payload protocol [...]
-
Page 757
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-11 Index event configuration accessing , 21-4 , 21-10 event ID event and shutdow n log entri es , 21 -12 event log (switch event) def init ion , 21-3 event log wraps event statistics , 21-14 event notif ication configur ing , 21-4 event statistics event log wraps , 21 -14 events dropped d ue to event system[...]
-
Page 758
IN-12 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x type , 22-1 1 forwarding ca che statistics monitoring , 22-4 forwarding in terface designated forward er(s) table parameter s , 12 -66 forw ar di ng rule s VLAN , 6-5 forwardi ng state (s panning tr ee bridge port) , 7-1 6 found o n interface DVMRP d ownstream de pe[...]
-
Page 759
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-13 Index grou p mu ltic a st pr otoc ol IGMP group members hip tabl e paramet ers , 12- 56 group repo rter address IGMP group members hip tabl e paramet ers , 12- 56 group reports received IGMP interface statistical parameters , 12-54 H hardware requirements for rou tin g , 12-3 , 16-4 hash mode Layer 3 cac[...]
-
Page 760
IN-14 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x IEEE 802.3 X P AUSE , 24-2 IEEE802.1D SPANNING TREE , 7-4 IGM P configuri n g , 12-31 Global statistics , 12-51 , 12 -53 , 12-55 over view , 12 -31 IGMP global statistic pa rameter s group mem b ership queries receive d , 12-52 group mem bership queries tran smitted[...]
-
Page 761
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-15 Index LGM P se rve r dis pl ay p e r VL A N pa ra m et e rs , 20-2 7 intelligent m ult icastin g , 20 -5 , 20-9 , 20-10 interface add IP interfac e parameters , 12 -8 AppleTalk ARP cache table statistics , 19-30 AppleTalk interface parameter s , 19 -5 AppleTalk interface statistics , 19-26 AppleTalk NBP [...]
-
Page 762
IN-16 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x filtering Web traffi c example , 13-1 3 IP addres s ARP cache search parameters , 12 -50 DVMRP interface parameters , 12-38 IGMP interface parameters , 12-33 IGMP interface statistical parameters , 12 -53 IP routing table s earch parameters , 12 -47 IP static ARP pa[...]
-
Page 763
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-17 Index IP routing glob al statistics , 12-43 IP routing glob al statistics BOOTP/DHCP in discards , 12-46 BOOTP/DHCP in hops exceeded , 12-46 BOOTP/DHCP in requests , 12-45 BOOTP/DHCP in responses , 12 -46 BOOTP/D HCP out r equests , 12-46 BOOTP/D H CP out r esponses , 12- 46 ICMP in address mas k reply ,[...]
-
Page 764
IN-18 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x node number , 16 -1 RIP interfaces , 17-1 routing table statistics , 16- 20 searching the rou te table , 16-18 searching the service table , 16 -21 socket num ber , 16- 1 IPX datagram fields checksum , 16-2 destination netwo rk , 16-3 destination node , 16-3 destina[...]
-
Page 765
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-19 Index ticks , 16-20 TTL , 16- 20 IPX route table search , 16-18 IPX route table statistics examining , 16- 20 IPX router configur ing , 16-4 , 16 -5 IPX routing IPX routing , 16 -5 IPX routing glob al statistics, disp lay ing , 16-16 , 16 -18 IPX routing table search par ameters interface , 16-19 network[...]
-
Page 766
IN-20 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x service name , 16-14 socket , 16 -14 type , 16-14 IPX st atic se rvic e p a rame ter s , 16-1 3 IPX st atic se rv ice s creating , 16-12 , 16-15 IPX syntax exam ple , 16-1 IRDP , 12-83 enabling on an interface , 12-83 IRDP ov erview , 12-83 IRDP paramet ers adv. add[...]
-
Page 767
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-21 Index settings , 12- 86 LDAP configurati on paramete rs primary serv er IP address , 12-87 primary se rver port , 12-87 search base , 12-88 secondary serv er IP address , 12 -87 secondary se rver port , 12-88 LDAP statistics cons umer sign al , 12-90 last change , 12-89 prod ucer sign al , 12-8 9 learned[...]
-
Page 768
IN-22 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x type , 15-27 LSAs OSPF statistical p arame ter s , 15 -20 M MAC Addr ess search , 9-14 , 9-15 MAC address address forwarding table parameters , 9-17 AppleTalk ARP cache table st atistics , 19 -30 filtering , 9-14 , 9-15 IP static ARP parameters , 12-2 3 multicast se[...]
-
Page 769
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-23 Index Modifying the DVMRP Global Config uratio n Using the CLI , 12-39 module features , 1-10 modules & ports , 6-30 , 8- 12 , 8-16 , 8- 21 , 8-28 , 8-29 , 8-39 monitori ng swit ch performance IP routing statistics , 12- 40 OSPF , 15-18 Monitoring the Forward ing Cache Statistics , 22-4 month summer [...]
-
Page 770
IN-24 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x AppleTalk static rou t e , 19- 1 1 netw ork ran ge s ta rt AppleTalk interface par ameters , 19-6 AppleTalk static rou t e , 19- 1 1 new cl i ent port s a dd ed IGMP sno oping , 20-21 new rou ter ports added IGMP sno oping , 20-21 new sessions created IGMP sno oping[...]
-
Page 771
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-25 Index stat ic ext type , 15-5 static low ext type , 15-5 OSPF inter-area routes IP global con figuration parameters , 12-13 OSPF interface parameters area , 15- 10 authentication , 15-1 1 cost , 15-11 dead interval , 15-11 DR priority , 15-10 hello interval , 15-10 interface , 15-10 IP address , 15-10 ke[...]
-
Page 772
IN-26 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x owne r AppleTalk route table statistics , 19-28 P packet length IPX datagram fields , 16-2 packet tracing enabling , 21- 8 , 21-10 packet type IPX datagram fields , 16-3 packets Ethernet interface statistical param eters , 23 -4 packets for warded through cache entr[...]
-
Page 773
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-27 Index PPP console settin gs baud rate , 2-28 flow contro l , 2-2 8 PPP console static route configur ing , 12-90 PPP serial p ort co nsol e , 2-34 regaining acce ss to the CLI , 2-32 PRE for warding cache (FE) parameters , 22-1 1 Layer 3 route cach e search parameters , 22-8 precedence IPX RIP f ilter pa[...]
-
Page 774
IN-28 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x rate limit burst si ze 10/1 00 p or t par ame ter , 8-2 7 rate limit mode 10/1 00 p or t par ame ter , 8-2 7 rate limit rate 10/1 00 p or t par ame ter , 8-2 7 realm RADIUS config urati on paramet ers , 4-27 receive new LSA count OSPF statistical p arame ter s , 15 [...]
-
Page 775
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-29 Index route add fai lures IPX routing table statis tic , 16-21 route metric DVMRP route table parameters , 12-64 route preference by pro tocol IP global con figuration parameters , 12-13 rout er c ost t o so urce netw ork DVMRP upstream routers , 12-65 router ID LSA detail , 15-27 OSPF global configur at[...]
-
Page 776
IN-30 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x LGMP server con figuration parameters , 20-24 service name IPX service table s earch parameter , 16-23 IPX st ati c se rvic e p a rame ter , 16-14 service port status event class parameters , 21-6 service ratio (queu es) , 1-2 0 , 24-2 service type IPX service table[...]
-
Page 777
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-31 Index name , 7-1 5 port , 7-15 stat e , 7-16 span ni ng tre e mode switch por t conf ig urati on para mete rs , 8-32 speed mode 10/100 por t parame ter , 8-26 SPF hold tim e OSPF global configur ation paramet ers , 15-4 SPF runs OSPF statisti cal parameters , 15-20 SPF susp en d OSPF global configur atio[...]
-
Page 778
IN-32 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x managing , 2-40 switch descript ion , 1-1 switch fabric event class parameters , 21-6 switch features crossb ar switch fabric, ov erview , 1-4 , 1-6 swit ch port configuri n g , 8-29 switch port configuration para m e ter s 3Com m ap ping table , 8-33 allow learning[...]
-
Page 779
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-33 Index IPX datagr am fields , 16-2 triggered upd ates IPX SAP interface parameters , 18-3 RIP gl obal configuration parameters , 14- 3 triggered u pdates sent IPX SAP interface statistical parameters , 17 -9 , 18-1 2 RIP statistical pa rameter s , 14-11 trunk mo de Cisco Cata l ys t 5000, para met e rs , [...]
-
Page 780
IN-34 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x upstream ro uter DVMRP rout e table parameters , 12-64 upstream s ource IGMP local multicast forwardi ng cache para mete rs , 12-57 upstream s ources , 12-71 DVMRP multicast forwarding cache parameters , 12-69 use default route use de faul t ro ute , 16 -5 use defau[...]
-
Page 781
Docu ment N o. 10 -3 00 077 , Issu e 2 IN-35 Index auto increment HT size , 6-10 initial hash tab le size , 6-10 VLAN considerations , 6-7 VLAN exchange parameters updater timestamp , 6-3 1 VLAN operation ingress rules , 6- 4 VLAN Operational Rules , 8-7 VLAN spanning tree bridge level parameters bridge forw ard delay , 7- 12 bridge hello time , 7-[...]
-
Page 782
IN-36 User Guid e for the Avaya P5 80 and P882 Mult iservice Switc hes, v6.1 Inde x AppleTalk interface par ameters , 19-6 AppleTalk NBP table param eters , 19- 33 AppleTalk static rou t e , 19- 1 1 zone filter adding interfaces , 19-21 , 19-22 creating , 19-19 deleting interfaces , 19-21 , 19 -22 editing , 19-20 zones AppleTalk route table statist[...]